1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.91"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
375 .cindex "documentation"
376 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379 capable of showing a change indicator.
382 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
391 .cindex "books about Exim"
392 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
397 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
402 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404 Debian-specific features in the file
405 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
409 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
412 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
418 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
423 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
426 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
432 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
442 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
448 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
451 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
466 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
472 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
483 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
490 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
492 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
495 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496 .cindex "bug reports"
497 .cindex "reporting bugs"
498 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
505 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
507 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
508 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
510 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
512 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
514 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
517 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
521 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524 here are top-level directories.
526 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
529 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
536 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
538 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541 most portable to old systems.
543 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
545 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
551 PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552 &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
555 At time of last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
560 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
566 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
567 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
570 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
575 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
580 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
584 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
586 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
587 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
594 .cindex "domainless addresses"
595 .cindex "address" "without domain"
596 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
602 .cindex "transport" "external"
603 .cindex "external transports"
604 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
611 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
616 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620 a number of common scanners are provided.
624 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
625 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
632 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
640 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
641 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
645 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
652 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653 .cindex "terminology definitions"
654 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657 below) by a blank line.
659 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666 rise to further bounce messages.
668 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
673 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
678 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
682 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
683 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
684 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
691 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
693 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
699 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
700 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
701 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
702 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
705 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
712 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
713 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
716 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
717 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
718 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
722 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
728 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
740 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
743 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744 .cindex "incorporated code"
745 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
748 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
751 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
758 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763 following statements:
766 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
768 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
772 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776 restrictions applied to it).
779 .cindex "SPA authentication"
780 .cindex "Samba project"
781 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
788 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793 conditions expressed therein.
796 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
798 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
803 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
806 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
811 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814 details, please contact
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
824 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
827 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
830 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
841 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
844 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
850 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
855 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861 software without specific, written prior permission.
863 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
873 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
881 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
883 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
893 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
897 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898 .cindex "design philosophy"
899 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
907 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
909 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
911 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
916 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
927 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
930 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
935 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
941 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
945 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947 runs at the start of every delivery process.
952 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
953 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
954 .cindex "Sieve filter"
955 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960 of filtering are available:
963 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
966 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
970 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
974 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976 .cindex "format" "of message id"
977 .cindex "id of message"
982 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
989 not always case-sensitive.
991 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
1000 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003 way of representing the date and time of day).
1005 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006 received the message.
1008 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1010 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1016 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018 (1/100) of a second.
1022 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1182 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1237 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases,
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1367 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1368 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373 of any other conditions.
1375 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1379 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1385 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1391 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1395 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1398 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399 of domains that it defines.
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1403 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1404 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1405 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1406 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1407 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1408 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1409 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1410 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1411 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1413 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1414 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1416 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1417 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1418 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1419 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1420 remaining preconditions.
1422 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1423 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1424 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1425 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1426 could lead to confusion.
1428 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1429 set of addresses that it defines.
1431 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1432 specified files is tested.
1434 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1435 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1436 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1437 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1441 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1442 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1443 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1444 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1445 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1446 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1447 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1451 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1452 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1453 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1456 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1457 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1458 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1459 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1460 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1462 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1463 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1465 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1466 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1467 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1468 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1469 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1470 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1473 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1474 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1475 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1476 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1477 processed entirely independently of each other.
1479 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1480 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1481 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1482 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1483 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1484 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1485 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1486 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1487 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1489 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1490 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1491 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1492 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1493 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1494 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1495 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1496 addresses to the same domain.
1498 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1499 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1500 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1501 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1502 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1503 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1504 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1505 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1507 .cindex "queue runner"
1508 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1509 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1510 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1511 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1512 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1513 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1514 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1515 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1516 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1518 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1519 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1520 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1521 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1522 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1523 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1525 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1526 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1527 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1528 messages to other addresses.
1530 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1531 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1532 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1535 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1536 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1537 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1543 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1544 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1545 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1546 .cindex "queue runner"
1547 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1548 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1549 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1550 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1551 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1552 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1553 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1554 passed its retry time.
1555 You can run several queue runners at once.
1557 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1558 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1559 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1560 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1561 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1566 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1567 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1568 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1569 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1570 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1571 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1572 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1573 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1574 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1577 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1578 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1579 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1581 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1582 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1583 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1584 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1585 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1590 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1591 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1592 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1593 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1594 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1595 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1596 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1597 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1598 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1599 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1600 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1602 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1603 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1604 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1607 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1608 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1609 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1610 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1611 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1612 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1613 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1618 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1619 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1620 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1621 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1622 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1623 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1624 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1625 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1631 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1634 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1635 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1637 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1638 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1639 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1640 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1643 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1644 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1646 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1647 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1648 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1649 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1653 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1654 following subdirectories are created:
1657 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1658 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1659 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1660 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1661 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1662 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1663 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1666 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1667 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1668 that may be useful to some sites.
1671 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1672 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1673 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1674 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1675 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1676 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1678 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1679 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1680 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1681 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1682 overridden if necessary.
1683 .cindex compiler requirements
1684 .cindex compiler version
1685 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1688 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1689 .cindex "PCRE library"
1690 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1691 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1692 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1693 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1694 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1695 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1696 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1697 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1698 If your operating system has no
1699 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1700 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1701 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1703 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1704 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1705 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1706 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1707 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1708 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1709 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1711 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1713 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1714 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1715 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1716 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1717 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1718 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1720 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1721 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1722 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1723 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1724 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1725 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1726 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1727 Berkeley DB library.
1729 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1730 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1734 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1735 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1737 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1738 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1739 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1740 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1741 file name is used unmodified.
1743 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1744 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1745 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1746 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1748 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1749 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1750 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1752 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1753 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1754 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1755 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1756 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1757 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1758 page with far newer versions listed.
1759 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1760 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1761 suited to Exim's usage model.
1763 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1764 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1765 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1766 operates on a single file.
1770 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1771 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1772 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1773 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1774 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1778 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1779 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1781 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1782 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1783 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1784 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1785 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1786 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1788 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1789 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1790 in one of these lines:
1795 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1796 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1797 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1798 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1801 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1802 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1804 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1805 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1809 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1810 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1811 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1812 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1813 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1814 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1815 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1816 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1817 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1818 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1819 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1820 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1822 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1823 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1824 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1825 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1826 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1827 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1829 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1830 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1831 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1832 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1833 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1834 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1837 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1838 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1839 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1840 facilities, you need to set
1842 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1844 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1845 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1848 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1849 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1850 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1851 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1852 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1853 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1854 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1856 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1857 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1858 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1859 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1860 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1865 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1866 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1868 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1869 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1870 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1871 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1872 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1873 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1874 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1876 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1877 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1878 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1879 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1880 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1884 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1888 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1889 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1890 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1891 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1892 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1893 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1894 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1895 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1896 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1897 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1900 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1901 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1904 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1907 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1909 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1910 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1913 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1914 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1916 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1917 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1920 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1922 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1923 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1927 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1929 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1930 library and include files. For example:
1934 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1935 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1937 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1938 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1942 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1945 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1946 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1947 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1952 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1954 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1955 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1956 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1957 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1958 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1959 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1960 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1961 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1962 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1963 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1964 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1965 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1968 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1969 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1970 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1972 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1973 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1975 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1977 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1978 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1979 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1980 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1981 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1982 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1986 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1987 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1988 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1989 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1990 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1991 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1994 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1995 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1996 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1997 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1998 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2000 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2005 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2006 .cindex "lookup modules"
2007 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2008 .cindex ".so building"
2009 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2010 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2012 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2013 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2015 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2017 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2018 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2019 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2020 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2021 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2022 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2024 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2025 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2026 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2035 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2036 .cindex "build directory"
2037 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2038 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2039 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2040 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2041 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2042 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2043 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2045 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2046 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2047 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2048 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2049 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2050 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2051 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2052 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2054 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2055 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2056 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2060 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2061 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2062 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2063 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2064 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2065 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2066 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2070 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2071 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2072 given in addition to the short output.
2076 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2077 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2078 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2079 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2080 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2081 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2082 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2085 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2086 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2089 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2090 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2091 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2093 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2094 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2095 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2096 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2097 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2098 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2099 and are often not needed.
2101 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2102 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2103 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2104 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2105 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2106 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2107 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2108 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2109 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2112 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2113 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2114 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2115 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2119 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2120 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2121 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2122 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2123 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2124 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2125 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2126 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2127 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2128 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2129 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2130 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2131 containing the lines
2136 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2137 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2139 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2140 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2141 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2144 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2146 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2147 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2148 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2149 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2150 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2151 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2152 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2153 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2159 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2160 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2161 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2162 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2163 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2164 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2165 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2166 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2169 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2170 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2171 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2172 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2173 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2174 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2175 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2176 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2177 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2178 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2179 syntax. For instance:
2182 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2184 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2185 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2186 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2189 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2190 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2191 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2195 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2196 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2198 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2199 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2200 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2201 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2202 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2203 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2206 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2209 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2210 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2213 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2214 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2216 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2217 definition of all three of these variables into your
2218 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2221 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2222 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2223 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2224 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2226 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2227 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2228 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2229 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2230 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2233 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2234 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2235 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2236 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2237 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2240 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2242 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2243 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2244 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2245 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2246 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2247 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2251 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2252 .cindex "building Eximon"
2253 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2254 where the files that are involved are
2256 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2257 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2261 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2263 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2264 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2265 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2266 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2267 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2268 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2269 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2273 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2274 .cindex "installing Exim"
2275 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2276 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2277 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2278 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2279 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2280 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2281 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2282 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2283 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2284 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2285 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2286 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2288 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2289 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2290 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2291 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2292 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2293 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2294 alternative files, no default is installed.
2296 .cindex "system aliases file"
2297 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2298 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2299 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2300 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2301 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2302 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2303 and outputs a comment to the user.
2305 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2306 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2307 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2308 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2309 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2311 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2312 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2313 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2314 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2315 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2318 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2319 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2322 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2324 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2325 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2326 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2327 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2328 but this usage is deprecated.
2330 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2331 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2332 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2333 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2334 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2335 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2337 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2338 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2339 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2340 for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2341 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2342 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2343 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2345 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2346 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2347 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2350 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2352 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2353 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2354 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2355 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2358 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2360 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2361 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2364 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2365 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2367 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2371 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2373 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2375 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2376 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2377 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2379 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2384 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2385 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2386 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2387 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2388 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2391 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2392 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2393 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2397 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2398 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2399 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2400 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2401 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2407 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2408 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2409 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2410 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2411 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2415 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2416 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2417 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2418 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2419 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2422 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2424 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2426 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2428 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2429 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2430 user agent. For example:
2432 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 From: user@your.domain.example
2434 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2435 Subject: Testing Exim
2437 This is a test message.
2440 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2441 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2442 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2444 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2445 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2446 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2447 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2448 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2449 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2451 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2453 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2454 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2455 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2456 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2457 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2459 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2460 .cindex "lock files"
2461 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2462 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2463 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2464 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2465 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2466 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2467 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2468 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2469 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2470 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2471 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2472 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2474 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2475 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2476 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2477 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2478 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2481 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2482 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2483 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2484 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2488 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2489 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2490 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2491 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2492 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2493 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2494 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2495 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2496 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2497 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2498 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2499 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2500 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2502 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2503 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2504 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2505 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2506 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2507 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2510 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2511 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2512 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2513 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2515 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2516 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2517 favourite user agent.
2519 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2520 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2521 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2522 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2523 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2524 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2528 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2529 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2530 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2531 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2532 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2533 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2534 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2535 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2541 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2542 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2543 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2545 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2547 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2548 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2549 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2550 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2551 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2553 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2555 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2557 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2558 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2559 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2567 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2568 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2569 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2570 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2571 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2572 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2573 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2574 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2575 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2578 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2580 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2581 were present before any other options.
2582 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2584 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2585 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2586 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2589 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2590 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2591 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2595 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2596 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2597 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2600 .cindex "queue runner"
2601 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2602 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2603 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2605 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2606 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2607 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2608 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2609 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2610 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2611 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2612 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2615 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2616 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2617 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2618 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2619 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2620 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2623 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2624 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2625 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2626 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2627 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2628 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2630 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2631 .cindex "envelope sender"
2632 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2633 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2634 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2635 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2636 users to set envelope senders.
2638 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2639 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2640 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2641 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2642 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2643 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2644 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2646 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2647 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2648 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2649 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2650 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2651 that are available to trusted users.
2653 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2654 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2655 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2656 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2657 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2659 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2660 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2661 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2662 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2664 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2665 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2666 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2667 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2669 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2670 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2675 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2676 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2677 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2683 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2684 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2685 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2686 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2687 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2688 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2689 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2690 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2692 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2693 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2694 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2695 . creates a man page for the options.
2696 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2699 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2706 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2707 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2708 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2709 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2712 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2713 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2714 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2717 .vitem &%--version%&
2718 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2719 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2726 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2729 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2731 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2732 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2733 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2734 clean; it ignores this option.
2739 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2740 .cindex "queue runner"
2741 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2742 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2743 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2745 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2746 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2747 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2748 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2750 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2751 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2752 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2753 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2755 When a listening daemon
2756 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2757 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2758 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2759 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2760 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2761 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2764 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2765 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2766 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2770 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2771 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2772 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2773 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2774 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2775 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2776 because these are reread each time they are used.
2780 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2781 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2785 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2786 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2787 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2788 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2789 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2790 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2792 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2793 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2794 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2795 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2796 test data. A line history is supported.
2798 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2799 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2800 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2801 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2802 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2803 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2804 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2806 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2807 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2808 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2809 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2811 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2812 defined and macros will be expanded.
2813 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2814 available to admin users.
2816 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2818 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2819 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2820 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2821 of a file. For example:
2823 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2825 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2826 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2827 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2828 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2829 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2830 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2831 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2834 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2836 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2837 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2838 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2839 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2840 system filters are recognized.
2842 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2844 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2845 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2846 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2847 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2848 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2849 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2850 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2851 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2854 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2855 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2856 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2858 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2860 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2861 variables that are used by the user filter.
2863 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2868 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2869 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2870 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2873 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2874 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2875 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2876 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2878 When testing a filter file,
2879 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2880 .cindex "envelope sender"
2881 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2882 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2883 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2884 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2885 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2888 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2890 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2891 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2892 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2895 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2897 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2898 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2899 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2900 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2901 actually being delivered.
2903 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2905 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2906 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2907 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2910 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2912 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2913 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2914 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2917 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2919 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2920 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2921 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2922 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2923 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2924 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2925 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2926 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2927 after a full stop. For example:
2929 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2930 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2932 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2933 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2934 conversion to the canonical form is
2935 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2937 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2938 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2939 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2940 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2941 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2945 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2946 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2947 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2950 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2951 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2952 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2954 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2955 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2956 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2957 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2958 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2959 session were authenticated.
2961 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2962 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2963 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2965 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2966 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2967 specialized SMTP test program such as
2968 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2970 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2972 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2973 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2974 updating the callout cache database.
2978 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2979 .cindex "building alias file"
2980 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2981 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2982 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2983 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2984 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2987 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2988 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2989 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2990 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2991 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2992 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2995 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2997 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2998 .cindex "querying exim information"
2999 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3000 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3001 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3002 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3003 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3006 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3007 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3008 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3009 recognised DSCP names.
3011 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3012 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3013 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3014 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3015 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3016 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3017 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3018 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3019 way to guarantee a correct response.
3023 .cindex "local message reception"
3024 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3025 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3026 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3027 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3028 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3029 if no other conflicting option is present.
3031 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3032 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3033 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3034 suppressing this for special cases.
3036 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3037 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3039 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3040 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3041 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3044 .cindex "message" "format"
3045 .cindex "format" "message"
3046 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3047 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3048 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3049 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3050 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3052 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3053 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3055 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3056 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3057 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3058 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3059 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3061 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3062 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3063 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3064 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3065 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3067 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3068 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3069 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3070 .cindex "malware scan test"
3071 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3072 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3073 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3074 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3075 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3076 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3077 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3079 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3080 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3081 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3082 This option requires admin privileges.
3084 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3085 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3086 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3090 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3091 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3092 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3093 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3094 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3095 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3096 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3098 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3099 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3100 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3101 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3102 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3104 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3105 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3106 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3107 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3112 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3113 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3114 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3115 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3116 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3117 arguments, for example:
3119 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3121 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3122 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3123 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3124 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3125 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3126 users, the output is as in this example:
3128 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3130 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3131 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3133 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3134 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3135 backward compatibility.)
3136 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3137 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3139 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3140 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3141 name will not be output.
3143 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3144 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3145 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3146 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3147 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3148 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3149 written directly into the spool directory.
3151 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3153 exim -bP +local_domains
3155 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3156 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3158 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3159 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3160 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3161 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3162 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3163 that driver are output. For example:
3165 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3167 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3168 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3169 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3170 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3171 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3174 .cindex "environment"
3175 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3176 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3179 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3180 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3181 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3182 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3183 The output format is one item per line.
3184 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3185 the exit status will be nonzero.
3189 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3190 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3191 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3192 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3193 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3194 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3195 to allow any user to see the queue.
3197 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3199 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3200 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3203 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3204 .cindex "size" "of message"
3205 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3206 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3207 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3208 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3209 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3210 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3211 before the sender address.
3213 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3214 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3215 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3217 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3218 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3219 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3220 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3221 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3227 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3228 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3229 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3235 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3236 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3237 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3238 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3243 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3244 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3245 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3246 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3250 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3254 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3259 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3260 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3261 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3262 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3267 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3268 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3269 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3270 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3271 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3273 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3274 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3276 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3277 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3278 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3279 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3280 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3281 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3282 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3283 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3284 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3286 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3287 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3292 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3293 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3294 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3295 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3296 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3297 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3298 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3302 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3303 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3304 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3305 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3306 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3307 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3308 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3309 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3310 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3312 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3313 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3314 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3316 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3317 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3318 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3319 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3321 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3322 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3323 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3325 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3326 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3327 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3328 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3329 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3331 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3332 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3336 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3337 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3338 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3339 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3340 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3341 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3342 messages to the MTA.
3345 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3346 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3347 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3348 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3349 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3350 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3351 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3355 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3356 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3357 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3358 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3359 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3360 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3361 the listening daemon.
3365 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3366 .cindex "address" "testing"
3367 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3368 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3369 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3370 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3371 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3373 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3374 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3376 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3377 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3380 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3381 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3382 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3383 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3384 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3387 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3388 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3389 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3390 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3392 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3393 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3394 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3395 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3398 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3399 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3401 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3402 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3403 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3404 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3405 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3406 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3411 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3412 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3413 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3414 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3415 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3416 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3418 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3419 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3420 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3421 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3422 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3423 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3424 dynamic testing facilities.
3428 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3429 .cindex "address" "verification"
3430 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3431 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3432 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3433 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3434 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3435 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3437 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3438 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3439 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3441 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3442 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3444 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3445 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3448 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3449 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3450 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3451 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3452 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3454 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3455 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3456 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3457 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3458 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3459 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3462 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3463 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3464 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3467 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3468 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3469 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3470 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3472 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3473 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3474 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3475 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3479 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3480 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3487 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3488 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3489 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3490 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3492 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3493 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3494 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3495 each port only when the first connection is received.
3497 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3498 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3500 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3502 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3503 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3504 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3505 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3506 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3507 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3508 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3509 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3510 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3512 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3513 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3514 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3515 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3516 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3517 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3518 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3519 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3520 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3522 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3523 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3524 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3525 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3526 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3527 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3528 on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3530 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3531 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3532 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3533 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3534 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3535 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3536 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3538 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3539 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3540 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3543 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3544 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3545 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3546 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3547 specified by this option.
3550 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3552 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3553 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3554 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3555 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3556 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3557 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3559 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3560 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3561 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3562 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3563 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3564 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3565 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3567 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3568 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3569 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3575 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3576 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3579 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3581 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3582 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3585 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3587 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3588 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3589 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3590 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3591 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3592 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3593 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3596 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3597 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3598 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3599 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3600 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3601 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3602 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3605 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3606 &`auth `& authenticators
3607 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3608 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3609 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3610 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3611 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3612 &`filter `& filter handling
3613 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3614 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3615 &`ident `& ident lookup
3616 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3617 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3618 &`load `& system load checks
3619 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3620 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3621 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3622 &`memory `& memory handling
3623 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3624 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3625 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3626 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3627 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3628 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3629 &`retry `& retry handling
3630 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3631 &`route `& address routing
3632 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3634 &`transport `& transports
3635 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3636 &`verify `& address verification logic
3637 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3639 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3640 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3641 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3642 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3643 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3644 turn everything off.
3646 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3647 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3648 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3649 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3650 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3653 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3654 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3655 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3656 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3657 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3660 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3661 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3665 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3666 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3667 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3668 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3669 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3670 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3673 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3674 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3676 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3678 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3679 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3680 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3681 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3684 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3685 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3686 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3687 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3691 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3692 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3693 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3694 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3695 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3696 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3697 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3698 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3701 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3702 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3703 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3704 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3705 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3707 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3709 .cindex "sender" "name"
3710 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3711 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3712 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3713 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3714 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3715 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3717 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3719 .cindex "sender" "address"
3720 .cindex "address" "sender"
3721 .cindex "trusted users"
3722 .cindex "envelope sender"
3723 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3724 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3725 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3726 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3729 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3730 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3731 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3732 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3735 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3736 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3737 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3738 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3739 examples of shell commands:
3741 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3742 exim -f "" user@domain
3744 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3745 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3748 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3749 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3750 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3751 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3754 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3755 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3756 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3757 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3758 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3759 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3763 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3764 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3766 control = suppress_local_fixups
3768 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3769 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3772 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3775 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3777 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3778 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3779 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3784 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3785 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3786 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3787 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3788 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3789 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3791 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3793 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3794 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3795 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3796 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3797 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3798 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3800 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3802 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3804 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3805 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3806 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3807 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3808 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3809 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3810 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3813 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3814 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3815 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3816 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3817 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3818 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3820 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3821 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3822 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3823 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3825 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3827 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3828 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3829 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3830 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3831 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3832 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3833 can be used only by an admin user.
3835 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3836 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3838 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3839 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3840 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3841 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3842 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3843 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3844 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3845 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3849 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3850 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3851 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3855 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3856 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3857 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3859 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3861 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3862 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3863 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3867 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3868 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3869 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3873 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3874 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3875 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3877 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3879 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3880 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3881 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3882 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3883 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3884 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3888 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3889 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3890 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3895 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3896 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3897 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3899 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3901 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3902 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3903 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3904 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3906 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3908 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3909 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3910 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3911 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3912 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3913 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3914 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3915 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3916 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3917 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3918 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3919 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3920 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3922 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3924 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3925 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3926 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3927 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3928 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3929 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3930 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3931 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3933 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3935 .cindex "freezing messages"
3936 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3937 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3938 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3939 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3940 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3941 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3944 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3946 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3947 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3948 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3949 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3950 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3951 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3952 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3953 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3956 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3958 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3959 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3960 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3961 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3962 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3964 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3966 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3967 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3968 .cindex "removing recipients"
3969 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3970 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3971 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3972 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3973 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3974 can be used only by an admin user.
3976 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3978 .cindex "removing messages"
3979 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3980 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3981 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3982 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3983 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3984 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3985 placed on the queue.
3990 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3991 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3992 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3996 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3998 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3999 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4000 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4001 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4002 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4003 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4004 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4005 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4006 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4008 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4010 .cindex "thawing messages"
4011 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4012 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4013 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4014 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4015 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4016 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4019 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4021 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4022 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4023 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4024 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4026 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4028 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4029 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4030 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4031 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4032 only by an admin user.
4034 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4036 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4037 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4038 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4039 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4040 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4042 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4044 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4045 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4046 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4047 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4051 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4052 treats it that way too.
4056 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4057 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4058 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4059 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4060 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4061 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4062 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4065 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4066 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4067 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4068 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4069 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4070 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4071 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4076 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4077 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4078 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4079 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4081 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4083 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4086 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4088 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4089 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4090 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4093 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4095 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4096 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4097 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4098 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4099 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4100 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4104 .cindex "background delivery"
4105 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4106 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4107 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4108 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4109 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4110 processes to finish.
4112 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4113 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4114 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4115 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4117 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4118 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4119 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4120 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4124 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4125 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4126 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4127 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4128 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4129 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4131 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4132 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4135 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4136 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4138 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4139 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4140 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4141 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4146 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4151 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4152 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4153 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4154 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4155 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4156 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4157 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4158 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4159 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4160 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4165 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4166 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4167 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4168 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4169 configuration file is in effect.
4171 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4172 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4173 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4174 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4175 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4176 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4177 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4178 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4179 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4184 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4185 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4186 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4189 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4191 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4192 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4193 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4194 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4198 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4199 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4200 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4201 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4202 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4206 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4207 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4208 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4209 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4210 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4214 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4215 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4220 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4221 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4226 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4227 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4228 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4229 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4230 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4231 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4234 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4235 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4237 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4239 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4240 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4241 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4242 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4243 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4244 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4246 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4247 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4249 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4251 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4252 followed by a colon and the port number:
4254 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4256 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4257 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4258 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4259 whichever one is last.
4261 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4263 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4264 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4265 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4266 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4267 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4268 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4270 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4272 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4273 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4274 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4275 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4276 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4277 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4279 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4281 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4282 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4283 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4284 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4285 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4286 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4287 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4288 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4290 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4292 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4293 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4294 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4295 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4296 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4298 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4300 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4301 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4302 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4303 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4304 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4305 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4306 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4308 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4309 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4310 is sending the bounce.
4312 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4314 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4315 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4316 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4317 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4318 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4319 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4320 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4321 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4322 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4323 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4325 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4327 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4328 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4329 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4330 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4331 uses the name it is given.
4333 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4335 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4336 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4337 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4338 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4339 used, when there is no default.
4343 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4344 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4345 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4346 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4350 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4351 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4352 whatever that means.
4354 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4356 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4357 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4358 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4359 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4360 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4361 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4362 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4364 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4366 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4367 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4368 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4369 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4370 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4372 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4374 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4375 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4376 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4377 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4378 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4379 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4383 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4385 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4387 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4388 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4389 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4390 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4391 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4392 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4393 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4394 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4398 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4399 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4400 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4401 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4406 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4407 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4408 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4409 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4412 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4414 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4416 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4418 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4419 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4420 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4421 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4422 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4423 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4427 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4428 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4429 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4430 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4431 and &%-S%& options).
4433 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4434 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4435 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4436 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4437 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4438 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4439 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4442 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4443 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4444 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4445 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4446 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4449 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4450 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4451 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4452 this to be repeated periodically.
4454 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4455 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4456 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4457 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4459 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4460 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4461 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4463 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4464 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4465 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4466 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4470 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4471 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4472 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4473 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4474 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4475 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4478 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4479 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4480 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4481 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4482 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4483 delivered down a single SMTP
4484 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4485 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4486 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4487 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4488 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4491 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4493 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4494 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4495 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4496 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4497 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4499 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4501 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4502 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4503 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4504 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4505 their retry times are tried.
4507 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4509 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4510 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4513 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4515 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4516 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4517 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4520 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4523 .cindex "named queues"
4524 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4525 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4526 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4527 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4528 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4529 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4531 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4532 will specify a queue to operate on.
4535 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4537 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4540 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4541 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4542 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4543 starting message id. For example:
4545 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4547 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4548 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4549 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4551 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4553 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4554 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4555 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4556 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4557 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4558 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4560 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4561 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4562 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4563 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4564 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4565 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4566 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4567 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4568 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4570 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4572 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4573 process every 30 minutes.
4575 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4576 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4578 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4580 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4583 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4585 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4587 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4589 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4590 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4591 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4592 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4593 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4594 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4595 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4597 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4598 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4599 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4600 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4601 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4602 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4604 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4605 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4607 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4609 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4610 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4611 applied to each queue run.
4613 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4614 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4615 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4616 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4617 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4618 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4619 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4620 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4621 address will be skipped.
4623 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4624 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4625 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4628 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4629 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4630 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4631 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4632 an arbitrary command instead.
4636 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4638 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4640 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4641 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4642 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4643 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4644 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4645 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4647 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4649 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4650 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4651 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4655 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4656 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4657 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4658 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4659 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4660 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4661 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4662 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4663 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4665 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4666 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4667 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4668 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4669 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4670 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4671 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4672 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4673 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4674 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4675 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4677 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4678 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4679 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4680 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4681 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4682 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4684 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4685 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4686 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4687 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4688 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4689 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4690 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4691 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4692 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4696 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4697 compatibility with Sendmail.
4699 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4700 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4701 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4702 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4703 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4704 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4705 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4706 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4711 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4712 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4713 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4714 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4715 set. Exim ignores this option.
4719 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4720 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4721 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4722 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4723 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4724 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4729 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4730 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4731 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4734 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4736 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4737 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4739 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4741 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4742 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4743 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4752 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4753 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4754 . creates a man page for the options.
4755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4758 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4765 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4769 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4770 "The runtime configuration file"
4772 .cindex "run time configuration"
4773 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4774 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4775 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4776 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4777 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4778 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4779 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4780 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4783 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4784 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4785 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4786 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4787 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4788 actually alter the string.
4790 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4791 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4792 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4793 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4794 existing file in the list.
4797 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4798 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4799 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4800 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4801 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4802 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4803 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4804 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4805 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4806 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4808 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4809 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4810 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4811 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4812 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4814 Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4815 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4816 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4817 compromise the Exim user account.
4819 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4820 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4821 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4822 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4823 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4824 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4829 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4830 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4831 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4832 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4833 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4834 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4835 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4836 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4837 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4838 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4839 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4841 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4842 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4843 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4844 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4845 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4846 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4847 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4848 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4849 message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4852 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4853 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4854 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4855 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4856 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4858 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4859 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4860 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4861 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4862 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4863 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4865 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4866 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4867 necessarily be discarded.
4868 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4869 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4870 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4871 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4872 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4873 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4875 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4876 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4877 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4878 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4879 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4880 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4881 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4883 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4884 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4885 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4889 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4890 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4891 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4892 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4893 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4894 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4895 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4896 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4899 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4902 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4903 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4904 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4906 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4907 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4908 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4910 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4911 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4912 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4914 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4915 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4916 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4917 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4920 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4921 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4922 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4924 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4925 want to use this feature, you must set
4927 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4929 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4930 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4933 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4934 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4935 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4936 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4938 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4939 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4940 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4941 and does not introduce a comment.
4943 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4944 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4945 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4946 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4947 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4949 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4950 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4951 change settings as required.
4953 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4954 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4955 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4956 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4957 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4962 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4963 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4964 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4965 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4966 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4967 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4970 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4971 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4973 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4974 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4975 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4976 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4977 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4980 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4981 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4982 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4983 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4985 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4986 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4989 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4992 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4993 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4998 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4999 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5000 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5001 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5002 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5003 definition, and must be of the form
5005 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5007 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5008 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5009 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5010 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5011 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5013 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5014 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5015 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5017 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5018 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5019 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5020 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5021 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5022 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5023 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5026 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5027 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5029 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5030 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5031 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5032 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5033 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5034 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5037 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5038 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5039 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5044 MAC == updated value
5046 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5047 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5048 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5049 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5053 MAC == MAC and something added
5055 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5056 from a number of other files.
5058 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5059 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5060 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5061 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5062 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5067 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5068 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5069 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5070 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5072 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5073 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5075 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5077 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5079 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5080 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5081 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5084 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5085 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5086 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5087 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5088 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5091 The following classes of macros are defined:
5093 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5094 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5095 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5096 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5097 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5098 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5099 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5100 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5101 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5102 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5103 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5104 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5107 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5110 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5111 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5112 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5113 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5114 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5115 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5116 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5118 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5119 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5120 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5124 message_size_limit = 50M
5126 message_size_limit = 100M
5129 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5130 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5131 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5132 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5133 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5135 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5136 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5137 in this line"& will always be true.
5139 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5140 to clarify complicated nestings.
5144 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5145 .cindex "common option syntax"
5146 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5147 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5148 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5149 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5150 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5151 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5152 space) and then the value. For example:
5154 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5156 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5157 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5158 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5159 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5160 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5161 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5162 word &"hide"&. For example:
5164 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5166 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5168 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5170 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5171 all instances of the same driver.
5173 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5174 that are found in option settings.
5177 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5178 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5179 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5180 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5181 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5182 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5183 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5184 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5185 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5186 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5187 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5188 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5193 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5198 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5203 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5204 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5205 .cindex "format" "integer"
5206 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5207 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5208 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5209 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5212 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5213 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5214 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5216 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5217 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5218 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5222 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5223 .cindex "integer format"
5224 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5225 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5226 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5227 Such options are always output in octal.
5230 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5231 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5232 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5233 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5234 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5238 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5239 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5240 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5241 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5242 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5252 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5253 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5254 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5258 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5259 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5260 .cindex "format" "string"
5261 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5262 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5263 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5264 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5265 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5266 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5267 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5268 therefore equivalent:
5270 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5271 trusted_users = uucp:\
5272 # This comment line is ignored
5275 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5276 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5277 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5278 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5279 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5282 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5283 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5284 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5286 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5287 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5291 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5292 character, that character replaces the pair.
5294 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5295 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5296 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5297 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5298 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5299 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5302 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5303 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5304 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5305 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5306 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5307 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5308 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5309 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5310 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5311 within a quoted configuration string.
5314 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5315 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5316 .cindex "format" "user name"
5317 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5318 .cindex "format" "group name"
5319 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5320 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5321 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5322 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5325 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5326 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5327 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5328 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5329 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5330 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5331 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5332 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5333 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5334 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5335 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5337 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5338 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5339 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5340 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5341 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5342 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5345 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5347 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5349 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5350 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5351 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5352 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5354 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5355 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5356 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5357 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5358 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5359 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5360 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5361 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5363 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5365 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5366 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5367 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5369 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5370 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5371 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5372 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5373 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5374 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5375 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5376 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5377 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5379 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5381 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5382 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5383 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5384 the value in quotes. For example:
5386 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5388 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5389 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5390 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5391 enclosing an empty list item.
5395 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5396 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5397 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5398 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5400 senders = user@domain :
5402 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5403 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5404 items, the second of which is empty:
5406 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5408 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5409 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5410 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5411 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5415 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5416 is at the end of the list.
5421 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5422 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5423 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5424 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5425 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5426 a sequence of lines like this:
5428 <&'instance name'&>:
5433 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5434 followed by three options settings:
5439 transport = local_delivery
5441 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5442 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5443 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5444 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5445 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5446 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5448 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5449 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5451 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5452 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5453 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5454 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5455 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5458 .cindex "generic options"
5459 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5460 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5461 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5462 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5463 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5464 .cindex "private options"
5465 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5466 they all have default values.
5468 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5469 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5470 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5472 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5473 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5474 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5475 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5476 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5477 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5478 configuration lines:
5483 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5484 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5485 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5486 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5492 command_timeout = 10s
5494 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5495 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5498 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5499 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5500 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5511 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5512 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5513 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5514 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5515 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5516 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5517 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5518 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5519 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5520 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5521 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5525 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5526 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5527 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5530 # primary_hostname =
5532 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5533 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5534 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5535 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5537 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5539 domainlist local_domains = @
5540 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5541 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5543 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5544 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5545 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5546 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5548 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5549 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5552 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5553 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5554 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5555 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5556 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5557 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5559 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5560 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5561 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5562 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5563 domain is permitted.
5565 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5566 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5567 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5568 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5569 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5570 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5572 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5573 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5574 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5576 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5578 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5579 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5581 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5582 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5583 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5584 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5585 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5586 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5587 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5588 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5589 contents of a message to be checked.
5591 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5593 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5594 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5596 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5597 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5598 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5599 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5601 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5603 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5604 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5605 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5607 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5608 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5609 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5610 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5611 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5612 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5613 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5615 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5617 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5618 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5620 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5621 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5622 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5623 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5624 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5625 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5626 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5627 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5628 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5629 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5630 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5631 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5632 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5633 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5634 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5635 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5637 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5638 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5639 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5640 which should be used in preference to 587.
5641 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5643 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5645 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5648 # qualify_recipient =
5650 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5651 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5652 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5653 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5654 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5655 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5657 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5658 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5659 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5660 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5662 # allow_domain_literals
5664 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5665 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5666 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5667 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5668 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5669 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5671 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5675 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5676 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5677 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5678 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5679 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5680 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5681 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5682 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5684 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5685 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5690 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5691 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5692 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5693 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5694 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5695 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5698 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5699 1413 (hence their names):
5702 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5704 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5705 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5706 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5707 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5708 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5709 information, you can change this.
5711 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5712 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5717 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5718 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5719 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5720 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5722 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5723 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5725 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5726 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5728 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5731 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5732 +tls_certificate_verified
5735 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5737 # percent_hack_domains =
5739 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5740 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5741 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5743 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5744 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5745 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5746 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5747 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5748 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5749 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5750 always bounce messages.
5752 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5753 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5755 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5756 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5757 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5758 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5759 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5761 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5762 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5763 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5764 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5765 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5768 # split_spool_directory = true
5771 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5772 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5773 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5774 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5775 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5776 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5777 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5779 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5782 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5783 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5784 that are not 8-bit clean.
5786 # accept_8bitmime = false
5789 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5790 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5791 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5792 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5793 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5794 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5796 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5797 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5801 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5802 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5803 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5804 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5805 It starts with the line
5809 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5810 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5811 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5813 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5814 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5815 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5816 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5817 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5818 result of the ACL processing.
5822 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5827 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5828 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5829 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5830 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5831 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5832 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5834 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5835 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5836 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5839 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5840 domains = +local_domains
5841 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5843 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5844 domains = !+local_domains
5845 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5847 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5848 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5849 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5850 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5851 in Internet mail addresses.
5853 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5854 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5855 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5856 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5857 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5858 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5859 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5860 policy of being as safe as possible.
5862 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5863 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5864 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5865 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5866 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5867 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5869 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5870 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5871 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5872 have to modify this rule.
5874 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5875 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5876 common convention of local parts constructed as
5877 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5878 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5879 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5880 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5881 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5882 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5884 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5885 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5886 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5887 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5888 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5889 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5890 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5892 accept local_parts = postmaster
5893 domains = +local_domains
5895 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5896 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5897 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5898 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5899 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5901 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5902 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5903 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5905 require verify = sender
5907 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5908 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5909 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5910 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5911 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5912 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5913 discusses the details of address verification.
5915 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5916 control = submission
5918 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5919 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5920 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5921 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5922 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5923 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5924 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5925 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5926 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5928 accept authenticated = *
5929 control = submission
5931 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5932 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5933 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5934 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5935 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5936 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5938 require message = relay not permitted
5939 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5941 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5942 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5944 require verify = recipient
5946 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5947 fails, the address is rejected.
5949 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5950 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5952 # dnslists = black.list.example
5954 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5955 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5956 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5957 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5959 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5960 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5961 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5964 # require verify = csa
5966 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5967 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5972 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5973 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5977 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5978 of this ACL are commented out:
5981 # message = This message contains a virus \
5984 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5985 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5986 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5987 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5989 # warn spam = nobody
5990 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5991 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5992 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5993 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5995 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5996 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5997 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5998 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5999 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6000 whatever the spam score.
6004 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6007 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6008 .cindex "default" "routers"
6009 .cindex "routers" "default"
6010 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6015 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6016 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
6017 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6018 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6019 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6022 # driver = ipliteral
6023 # domains = !+local_domains
6024 # transport = remote_smtp
6026 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6027 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6028 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6029 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6030 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6034 domains = ! +local_domains
6035 transport = remote_smtp
6036 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6039 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6040 domains. This is specified by the line
6042 domains = ! +local_domains
6044 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6045 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6046 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6047 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6048 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6049 passed on to the following routers.
6051 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6052 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6053 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6054 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6055 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6057 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6058 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6059 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6060 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6061 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6062 the address fails and is bounced.
6064 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6065 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6066 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6067 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6068 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6069 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6070 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6077 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6079 file_transport = address_file
6080 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6082 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6083 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6084 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6085 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6086 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6089 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6090 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6091 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6092 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6097 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6098 # local_part_suffix_optional
6099 file = $home/.forward
6104 file_transport = address_file
6105 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6106 reply_transport = address_reply
6108 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6109 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6110 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6111 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6112 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6115 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6116 # local_part_suffix_optional
6118 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6119 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6120 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6121 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6122 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6123 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6124 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6126 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6127 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6128 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6129 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6131 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6132 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6133 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6134 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6135 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6136 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6137 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6139 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6140 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6141 There are two reasons for doing this:
6144 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6145 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6148 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6149 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6150 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6151 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6155 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6156 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6157 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6158 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6160 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6161 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6162 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6164 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6166 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6172 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6173 # local_part_suffix_optional
6174 transport = local_delivery
6176 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6177 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6178 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6179 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6180 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6183 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6184 .cindex "default" "transports"
6185 .cindex "transports" "default"
6186 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6187 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6188 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6192 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6198 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6199 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6200 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6201 It is negotiated between client and server
6202 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6203 All other options are defaulted.
6207 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6214 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6215 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6216 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6217 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6218 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6219 show how this can be done.
6221 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6222 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6223 similarly-named options above.
6229 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6230 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6231 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6232 be returned to the sender.
6240 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6241 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6242 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6247 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6252 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6253 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6254 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6255 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6256 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6257 introduced by the line
6261 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6264 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6266 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6267 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6268 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6269 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6270 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6272 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6273 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6274 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6277 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6278 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6282 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6283 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6287 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6288 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6289 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6291 begin authenticators
6293 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6294 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6295 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6296 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6297 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6298 to support most MUA software.
6300 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6303 # driver = plaintext
6304 # server_set_id = $auth2
6305 # server_prompts = :
6306 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6307 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6309 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6312 # driver = plaintext
6313 # server_set_id = $auth1
6314 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6315 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6316 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6319 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6320 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6321 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6322 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6323 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6324 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6325 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6326 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6328 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6329 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6330 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6331 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6333 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6334 usercode and password are in different positions.
6335 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6337 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6341 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6342 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6344 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6346 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6348 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6349 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6350 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6351 regular expressions is discussed in
6352 online Perl manpages, in
6353 many Perl reference books, and also in
6354 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6355 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6356 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6357 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6358 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6360 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6361 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6362 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6363 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6364 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6367 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6368 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6369 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6370 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6372 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6374 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6375 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6376 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6377 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6378 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6379 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6382 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6383 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6384 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6385 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6386 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6387 match anywhere in the subject string.
6389 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6390 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6392 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6394 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6397 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6399 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6400 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6405 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6407 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6408 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6409 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6410 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6411 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6412 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6415 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6416 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6417 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6418 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6419 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6420 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6422 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6423 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6424 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6425 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6426 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6427 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6430 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6431 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6432 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6433 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6434 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6435 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6437 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6438 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6439 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6440 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6441 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6443 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6444 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6446 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6447 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6448 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6449 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6450 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6452 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6453 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6455 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6456 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6458 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6459 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6460 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6465 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6466 matches the list item.
6468 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6469 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6471 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6473 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6474 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6475 causes a second lookup to occur.
6477 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6478 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6479 lookup is permitted.
6482 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6483 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6484 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6485 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6488 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6489 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6490 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6492 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6493 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6494 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6495 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6498 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6499 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6500 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6505 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6506 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6507 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6512 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6513 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6514 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6515 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6518 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6519 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6520 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6521 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6522 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6523 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6524 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6525 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6526 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6528 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6529 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6530 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6531 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6533 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6534 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6535 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6536 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6537 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6539 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6540 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6541 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6542 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6543 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6544 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6545 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6547 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6548 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6549 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6550 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6551 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6552 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6553 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6555 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6556 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6558 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6559 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6560 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6561 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6562 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6563 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6564 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6566 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6567 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6568 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6570 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6571 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6572 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6573 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6574 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6575 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6576 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6577 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6578 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6579 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6581 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6582 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6583 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6584 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6585 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6586 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6587 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6588 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6589 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6591 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6592 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6593 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6594 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6595 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6596 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6597 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6599 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6600 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6601 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6602 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6604 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6605 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6606 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6607 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6608 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6610 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6611 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6612 lookup types support only literal keys.
6614 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6615 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6616 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6618 .cindex "linear search"
6619 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6620 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6621 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6622 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6623 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6624 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6625 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6626 in the file is used.
6628 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6629 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6630 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6631 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6632 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6637 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6638 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6639 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6640 wildcarding of any kind.
6642 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6643 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6644 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6645 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6646 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6647 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6648 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6649 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6650 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6653 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6654 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6655 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6656 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6657 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6658 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6659 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6660 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6663 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6664 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6665 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6666 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6667 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6668 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6669 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6670 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6671 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6673 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6674 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6675 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6676 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6678 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6679 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6682 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6684 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6685 *fish data for anythingfish
6688 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6689 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6691 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6693 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6694 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6695 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6697 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6699 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6700 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6701 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6703 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6706 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6707 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6708 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6709 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6710 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6712 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6713 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6714 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6715 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6716 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6719 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6720 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6721 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6724 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6726 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6729 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6730 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6731 be followed by optional colons.
6733 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6734 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6735 lookup types support only literal keys.
6738 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6739 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6740 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6741 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6745 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6746 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6747 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6748 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6749 many of them are given in later sections.
6752 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6753 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6754 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6755 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6756 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6758 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6759 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6760 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6762 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6763 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6764 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6765 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6766 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6767 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6768 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6770 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6771 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6772 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6773 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6775 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6776 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6777 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6778 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6780 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6781 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6782 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6783 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6785 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6786 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6787 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6788 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6789 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6790 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6791 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6792 password value. For example:
6794 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6797 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6798 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6799 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6800 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6803 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6804 .cindex lookup Redis
6805 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6806 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6809 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6810 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6811 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6812 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6815 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6816 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6818 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6819 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6820 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6821 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6822 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6823 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6824 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6825 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6826 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6827 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6829 require condition = \
6830 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6832 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6833 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6834 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6835 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6840 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6842 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6843 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6844 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6845 options such as a list of local domains.
6847 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6848 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6849 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6850 or may give up altogether.
6854 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6855 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6856 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6857 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6858 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6859 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6860 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6861 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6863 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6864 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6865 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6867 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6868 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6869 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6871 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6872 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6873 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6874 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6875 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6876 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6877 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6878 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6879 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6880 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6882 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6884 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6885 looks up these keys, in this order:
6891 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6892 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6893 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6894 Exim move on to try the next key.
6898 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6899 .cindex "partial matching"
6900 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6901 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6902 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6903 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6904 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6905 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6906 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6907 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6908 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6909 a key in a DBM file is
6911 *.dates.fict.example
6913 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6914 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6915 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6918 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6919 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6920 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6922 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6923 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6924 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6925 partial matching keys
6926 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6927 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6928 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6930 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6931 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6932 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6933 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6934 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6935 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6938 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6939 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6940 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6941 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6942 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6943 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6945 2250.dates.fict.example
6946 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6947 *.dates.fict.example
6950 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6953 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6954 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6955 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6956 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6957 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6958 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6960 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6962 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6963 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6964 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6965 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6967 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6969 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6970 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6972 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6973 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6974 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6977 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6979 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6980 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6982 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6983 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6984 for &"*"& on its own.
6986 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6990 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6991 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6992 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6993 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6994 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6995 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6996 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6998 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6999 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7000 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7001 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7002 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7007 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7008 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7009 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7010 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7011 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7012 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7013 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7015 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7016 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7017 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7018 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7019 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7020 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7022 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7023 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7029 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7030 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7031 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7032 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7033 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7034 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7038 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7039 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7041 [name="$local_part"]
7043 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7044 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7045 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7046 of the following form is provided:
7048 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7050 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7052 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7054 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7055 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7056 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7061 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7062 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7063 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7064 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7065 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7066 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7067 an expansion string could contain:
7069 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7071 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7072 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7073 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7074 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7076 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7077 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7078 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7080 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7081 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7082 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7083 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7084 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7086 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7088 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7089 white space is ignored.
7090 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7091 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7092 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7094 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7095 When the type is PTR,
7096 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7097 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7099 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7101 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7102 altered and nothing is added.
7104 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7105 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7106 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7107 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7108 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7109 The field separator can be modified as above.
7111 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7112 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7113 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7114 unless a field separator is specified.
7115 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7117 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7119 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7120 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7121 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7123 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7124 white space is ignored.
7126 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7127 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7128 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7129 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7132 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7135 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7136 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7137 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7138 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7139 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7140 each followed by a comma,
7141 that may appear before the record type.
7143 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7144 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7145 a defer-option modifier.
7146 The possible keywords are
7147 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7148 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7149 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7150 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7151 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7152 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7153 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7155 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7156 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7158 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7159 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7161 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7162 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7163 The possible keywords are
7164 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7165 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7167 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7168 is not labelled as authenticated data
7169 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7170 The default is &"never"&.
7172 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7174 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7175 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7176 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7177 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7179 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7181 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7182 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7183 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7185 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7186 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7188 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7189 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7190 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7193 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7194 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7195 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7196 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7197 the pseudo-type MXH:
7199 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7201 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7204 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7205 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7206 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7207 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7208 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7209 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7210 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7211 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7213 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7214 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7216 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7217 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7218 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7220 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7221 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7222 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7223 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7224 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7227 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7228 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7229 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7230 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7231 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7232 result of a successful lookup such as:
7234 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7236 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7237 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7238 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7240 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7241 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7242 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7243 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7245 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7249 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7250 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7251 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7252 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7253 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7255 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7256 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7257 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7259 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7260 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7261 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7262 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7264 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7265 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7266 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7271 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7272 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7273 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7274 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7275 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7276 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7277 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7278 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7279 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7280 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7281 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7282 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7284 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7285 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7286 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7287 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7288 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7290 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7291 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7293 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7294 the way they handle the results of a query:
7297 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7300 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7301 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7303 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7304 from all of them are returned.
7308 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7309 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7310 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7311 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7314 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7315 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7316 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7317 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7319 data = ${lookup ldap \
7320 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7321 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7323 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7324 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7325 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7326 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7328 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7329 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7330 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7332 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7333 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7334 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7335 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7336 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7337 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7338 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7339 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7343 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7344 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7345 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7346 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7347 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7348 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7350 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7351 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7359 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7360 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7364 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7366 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7370 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7372 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7374 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7376 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7377 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7378 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7382 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7383 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7384 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7386 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7390 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7392 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7394 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7396 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7397 authentication below.
7400 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7401 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7402 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7403 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7404 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7407 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7409 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7410 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7411 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7412 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7413 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7414 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7415 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7416 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7417 failures, and timeouts.
7419 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7420 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7421 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7422 doubled. For example
7424 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7426 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7427 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7428 the local host) is used.
7430 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7431 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7432 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7433 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7436 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7437 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7438 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7439 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7441 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7443 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7444 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7446 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7448 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7449 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7450 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7451 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7452 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7453 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7454 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7457 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7458 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7459 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7462 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7465 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7469 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7470 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7474 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7475 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7476 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7477 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7478 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7479 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7480 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7481 them. The following names are recognized:
7483 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7484 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7485 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7486 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7487 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7488 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7489 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7490 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7492 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7493 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7494 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7495 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7497 .cindex LDAP timeout
7498 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7499 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7500 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7501 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7502 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7503 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7504 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7505 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7506 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7507 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7509 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7510 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7512 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7513 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7514 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7515 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7516 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7517 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7518 alternate list (colon-separated).
7520 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7521 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7524 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7525 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7528 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7529 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7530 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7531 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7533 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7534 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7535 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7537 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7538 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7539 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7540 quoting has two advantages:
7543 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7544 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7546 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7549 For example, a setting such as
7551 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7553 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7555 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7556 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7557 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7558 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7562 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7563 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7568 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7569 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7570 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7571 as a sequence of values, for example
7573 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7575 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7576 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7577 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7578 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7579 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7582 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7583 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7584 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7585 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7587 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7588 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7589 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7590 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7591 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7592 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7593 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7594 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7595 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7597 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7598 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7599 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7600 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7601 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7604 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7607 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7610 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7611 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7613 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7614 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7616 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7617 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7620 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7621 results of LDAP lookups.
7622 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7623 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7624 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7625 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7626 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7627 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7632 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7633 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7634 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7635 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7636 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7637 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7638 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7639 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7641 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7643 might return the string
7645 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7646 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7648 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7650 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7656 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7657 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7658 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7662 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7663 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7664 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7665 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7666 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7667 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7668 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7669 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7670 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7671 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7672 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7673 .cindex lookup Redis
7674 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7676 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7679 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7682 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7683 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7685 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7690 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7692 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7693 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7694 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7698 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7699 with a newline between the data for each row.
7702 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7703 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7704 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7705 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7706 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7707 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7708 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7709 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7710 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7711 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7712 .cindex lookup Redis
7713 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7714 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7715 or &%redis_servers%&
7716 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7718 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7719 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7720 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7722 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7723 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7724 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7725 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7727 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7729 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7730 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7731 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7733 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7734 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7736 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7737 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7738 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7739 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7740 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7741 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7743 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7744 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7745 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7747 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7748 host, database number, and password.
7750 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7751 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7752 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7754 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7756 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7759 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7760 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7761 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7762 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7764 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7765 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7767 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7768 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7769 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7770 done by starting the query with
7772 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7774 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7776 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7777 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7778 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7781 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7783 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7784 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7785 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7787 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7788 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7789 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7792 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7796 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7798 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7800 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7801 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7802 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7804 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7808 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7809 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7810 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7811 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7812 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7813 the default value is &"exim"&.
7814 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7816 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7817 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7819 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7820 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7822 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7825 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7826 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7828 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7829 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7830 is zero because no rows are affected.
7833 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7834 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7835 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7836 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7837 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7840 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7842 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7843 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7844 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7846 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7847 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7850 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7851 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7852 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7853 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7854 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7855 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7856 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7857 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7858 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7860 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7861 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7863 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7865 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7866 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7868 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7869 quote, which it doubles.
7871 .cindex timeout SQLite
7872 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7873 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7874 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7875 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7876 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7877 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7878 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7881 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7882 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7883 .cindex "redis lookup type"
7884 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7887 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7888 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7891 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7892 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7893 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7894 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7897 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
7898 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7899 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7909 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7910 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7911 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7912 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7913 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7914 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7915 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7916 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7917 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7919 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7920 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7921 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7922 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7924 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7925 support all the complexity available in
7926 domain, host, address and local part lists.
7930 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7931 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7932 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7934 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7935 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7938 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7939 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7940 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7941 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7942 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7945 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7946 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7947 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7949 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7950 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7951 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7952 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7953 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7955 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7956 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7958 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7959 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7960 senders based on the receiving domain.
7965 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7966 .cindex "list" "negation"
7967 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7968 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7969 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7970 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7971 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7972 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7974 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7975 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7976 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7977 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7978 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7980 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7982 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7983 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7984 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7986 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7988 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7989 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7990 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7992 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7993 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7998 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7999 .cindex "list" "file name in"
8000 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
8001 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8002 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8003 file names are not allowed,
8004 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8005 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8009 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8010 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8012 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8013 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8014 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8016 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8020 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8021 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8022 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8023 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8025 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8026 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8028 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8030 and the file contains the lines
8035 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8036 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8040 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8041 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8042 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8043 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8044 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8045 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8046 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8047 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8049 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8050 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8051 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8052 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8057 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8058 .cindex "named lists"
8059 .cindex "list" "named"
8060 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8061 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8062 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8063 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8064 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8065 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8066 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8068 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8070 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8071 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8072 configured with the line
8074 domains = +local_domains
8076 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8077 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8081 domains = ! +local_domains
8082 transport = remote_smtp
8085 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8086 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8087 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8088 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8090 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8091 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8093 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8095 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8096 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8097 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8099 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8100 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8101 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8103 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8104 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8106 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8107 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8108 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8110 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8112 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8113 referenced lists if you can.
8115 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8116 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8117 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8119 domains = +local_domains
8121 on several of your routers
8122 or in several ACL statements,
8123 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8124 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8125 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8126 the same each time they are referenced.
8128 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8129 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8130 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8131 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8135 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8136 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8137 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8138 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8139 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8142 ALIST = host1 : host2
8143 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8145 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8147 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8149 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8152 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8153 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8155 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8157 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8161 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8162 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8163 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8164 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8165 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8166 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8167 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8168 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8169 message. For example:
8171 domainlist special_domains = \
8172 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8174 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8175 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8176 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8177 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8178 same list each time.
8180 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8181 cache the result anyway. For example:
8183 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8185 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8186 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8190 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8191 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8192 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8193 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8194 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8197 .cindex "primary host name"
8198 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8199 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8200 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8201 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8202 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8203 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8204 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8205 differ only in their names.
8207 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8208 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8209 .cindex "domain literal"
8210 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8211 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8212 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8213 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8214 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8215 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8218 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8219 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8220 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8221 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8222 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8223 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8224 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8225 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8226 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8227 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8228 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8230 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8231 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8232 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8233 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8234 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8236 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8237 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8238 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8239 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8240 on a router). For example:
8242 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8244 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8245 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8247 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8248 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8249 contain negative items.
8251 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8252 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8253 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8255 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8256 an.other.domain : ...
8258 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8259 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8261 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8262 an.other.domain ? ...
8265 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8266 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8267 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8268 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8269 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8270 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8271 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8272 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8273 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8277 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8278 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8279 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8280 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8281 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8282 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8283 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8284 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8285 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8287 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8288 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8289 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8290 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8291 expression by expansion, of course).
8293 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8294 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8295 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8296 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8297 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8298 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8300 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8302 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8303 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8304 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8305 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8306 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8307 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8308 other statements in the same ACL.
8311 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8312 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8314 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8316 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8317 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8320 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8321 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8322 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8323 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8324 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8325 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8328 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8329 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8330 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8331 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8333 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8334 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8336 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8337 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8338 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8339 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8340 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8342 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8343 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8344 between the pattern and the domain.
8347 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8349 domainlist funny_domains = \
8352 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8353 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8354 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8355 nis;domains.byname : \
8356 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8358 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8359 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8360 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8361 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8362 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8367 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8368 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8369 .cindex "list" "host list"
8370 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8371 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8372 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8373 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8374 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8375 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8376 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8379 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8380 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8381 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8382 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8383 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8384 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8387 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8388 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8389 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8393 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8394 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8395 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8396 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8397 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8398 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8399 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8402 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8403 inspecting its IP address:
8406 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8407 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8408 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8409 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8410 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8411 with the IP address of the subject host.
8413 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8414 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8415 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8416 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8417 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8420 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8421 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8422 domain name, as just described.
8425 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8426 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8427 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8428 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8429 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8430 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8431 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8432 that can never match a client host.
8435 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8436 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8437 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8438 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8440 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8444 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8445 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8446 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8447 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8448 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8449 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8450 significant end of the address.
8452 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8453 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8454 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8455 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8459 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8460 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8463 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8465 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8466 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8468 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8469 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8472 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8474 could make use of a file containing
8479 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8480 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8481 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8483 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8486 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8492 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8493 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8494 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8495 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8496 address, the pattern takes this form:
8498 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8502 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8504 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8505 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8506 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8507 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8508 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8509 returned by the lookup is not used.
8511 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8512 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8513 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8514 patterns of this form:
8516 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8520 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8522 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8523 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8524 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8525 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8526 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8528 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8529 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8530 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8531 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8532 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8533 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8534 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8535 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8536 addresses are always used.
8538 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8539 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8540 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8543 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8544 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8545 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8546 case the IP address is used on its own.
8550 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8551 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8552 .cindex "unknown host name"
8553 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8554 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8555 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8556 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8557 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8560 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8561 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8562 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8563 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8564 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8565 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8566 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8568 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8569 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8571 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8572 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8573 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8574 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8575 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8576 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8577 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8578 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8579 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8581 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8582 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8584 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8585 .cindex "alias for host"
8586 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8587 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8590 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8591 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8592 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8593 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8594 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8597 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8598 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8599 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8600 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8601 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8602 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8603 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8608 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8609 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8610 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8611 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8612 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8614 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8616 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8617 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8618 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8625 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8626 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8627 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8628 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8629 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8630 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8632 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8633 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8635 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8636 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8637 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8638 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8639 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8640 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8641 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8642 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8643 not recognized in an indirected file).
8646 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8647 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8649 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8651 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8652 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8655 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8656 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8659 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8662 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8663 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8664 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8667 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8668 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8671 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8673 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8675 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8676 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8677 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8680 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8681 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8682 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8684 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8686 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8687 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8688 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8689 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8690 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8691 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8692 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8695 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8696 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8698 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8699 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8701 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8702 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8703 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8708 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8710 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8711 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8712 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8713 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8714 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8715 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8716 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8717 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8718 host lists such as whitelists.
8722 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8723 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8724 .cindex "unknown host name"
8725 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8726 If a pattern is of the form
8728 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8732 dbm;/host/accept/list
8734 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8735 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8738 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8739 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8740 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8741 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8742 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8743 lookup, both using the same file.
8747 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8748 If a pattern is of the form
8750 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8752 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8753 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8754 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8756 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8757 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8759 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8760 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8761 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8764 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8765 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8766 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8768 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8769 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8770 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8771 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8772 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8773 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8779 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8780 .cindex "list" "address list"
8781 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8782 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8783 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8784 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8785 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8786 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8787 using this option setting:
8791 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8792 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8793 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8794 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8796 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8799 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8801 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8802 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8803 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8804 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8805 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8806 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8807 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8809 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8810 *@+hostile_domains:\
8811 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8812 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8814 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8815 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8816 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8817 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8818 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8820 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8821 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8822 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8823 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8824 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8826 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8829 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8830 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8834 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8835 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8836 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8837 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8838 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8839 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8840 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8842 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8843 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8845 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8846 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8849 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8850 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8851 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8854 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8855 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8856 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8858 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8859 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8860 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8861 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8863 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8864 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8866 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8867 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8868 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8869 default. For example, with this lookup:
8871 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8873 the file could contains lines like this:
8875 user1@domain1.example
8878 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8881 nimrod@jaeger.example
8885 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8886 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8888 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8890 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8891 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8893 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8894 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8895 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8899 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8900 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8905 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8906 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8907 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8908 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8909 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8910 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8911 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8912 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8913 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8915 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8916 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8917 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8918 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8919 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8922 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8924 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8926 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8928 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8930 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8931 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8932 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8933 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8934 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8935 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8937 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8940 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8943 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8944 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8945 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8946 might have entries like
8948 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8949 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8952 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8953 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8954 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8955 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8957 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8958 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8959 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8962 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8963 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8964 can only return a single list of local parts.
8967 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8968 in these two examples:
8971 senders = *@+my_list
8973 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8974 example it is a named domain list.
8979 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8980 .cindex "case of local parts"
8981 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8982 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8983 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8984 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8985 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8986 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8987 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8988 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8991 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8992 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8993 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8994 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8995 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8996 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8997 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9000 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9001 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9002 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9003 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9004 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9005 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9006 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9007 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9011 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9012 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9013 .cindex "local part" "list"
9014 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9015 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9016 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9017 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9018 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9019 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9020 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9021 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9023 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9024 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9025 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9026 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9027 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9028 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9029 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9031 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9036 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9037 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9039 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9040 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9041 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9042 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9044 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9045 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9046 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9047 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9048 escape character, as described in the following section.
9050 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9051 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9052 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9053 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9054 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9059 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9060 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9061 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9062 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9063 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9064 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9065 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9066 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9068 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9069 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9070 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9071 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9073 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9075 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9076 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9081 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9082 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9083 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9084 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9085 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9086 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9087 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9090 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9091 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9092 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9095 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9096 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9097 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9099 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9100 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9101 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9102 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9103 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9104 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9105 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9108 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9109 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9110 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9113 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9114 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9115 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9116 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9118 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9120 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9121 Exim message identifier. For example:
9123 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9125 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9126 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9129 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9130 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9131 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9132 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9133 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9134 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9135 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9136 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9137 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9138 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9139 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9140 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9146 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9147 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9148 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9149 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9150 white space is significant.
9153 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9154 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9155 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9160 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9161 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9162 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9163 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9164 given, the expansion fails.
9166 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9167 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9168 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9169 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9173 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9174 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9175 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9176 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9177 string easier to understand.
9179 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9180 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9181 expansion item below.
9184 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9185 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9186 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9187 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9188 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9189 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9190 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9191 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9192 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9193 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9194 the result of the expansion.
9195 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9196 the expansion result is an empty string.
9197 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9200 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9201 .cindex authentication "results header"
9202 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9203 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9204 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9205 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9207 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9208 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9209 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9218 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9220 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9222 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9225 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9226 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9227 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9228 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9229 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9230 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9231 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9232 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9236 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9237 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9242 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9246 If the field is found,
9247 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9248 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9249 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9250 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9252 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9253 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9256 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9258 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9259 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9261 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9262 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9263 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9264 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9265 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9266 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9267 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9268 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9270 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9271 take an optional modifier of "int"
9272 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9273 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9274 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9276 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9277 newline-separated by default,
9278 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9279 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9280 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9282 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9283 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9284 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9285 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9286 if so the element tags are omitted.
9288 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9290 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9291 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9293 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9294 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9298 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9299 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9300 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9302 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9303 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9304 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9305 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9306 must have the following type:
9308 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9310 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9311 function should return one of the following values:
9313 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9314 into the expanded string that is being built.
9316 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9317 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9319 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9320 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9322 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9324 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9325 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9326 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9329 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9330 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9331 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9332 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9334 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9335 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9336 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9338 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9339 appear, for example:
9341 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9343 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9344 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9346 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9348 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9351 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9352 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9355 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9356 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9357 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9358 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9359 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9360 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9361 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9362 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9364 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9367 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9368 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9369 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9370 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9371 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9372 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9373 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9374 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9375 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9377 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9378 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9379 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9382 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9383 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9385 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9386 appear, for example:
9388 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9390 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9391 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9394 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9395 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9396 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9397 .cindex JSON expansions
9398 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9399 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9400 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9401 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9403 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9406 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9407 the spaces are optional.
9408 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9409 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9411 The results of matching are handled as above.
9415 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9416 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9417 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9418 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9419 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9420 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9421 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9422 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9423 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9424 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9425 <&'string3'&> as before.
9427 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9428 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9429 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9430 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9431 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9432 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9433 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9434 provided. For example:
9436 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9440 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9442 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9443 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9447 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9448 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9449 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9450 .cindex JSON expansions
9451 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9452 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9454 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9455 there is no choice of field separator.
9459 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9460 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9461 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9463 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9464 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9465 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9466 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9467 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9468 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9469 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9471 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9473 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9474 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9477 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9478 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9479 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9480 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9481 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9482 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9484 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9485 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9486 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9487 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9489 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9491 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9492 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9493 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9494 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9495 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9497 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9499 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9500 letters appear. For example:
9502 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9503 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9504 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9507 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9508 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9509 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9510 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9511 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9512 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9513 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9514 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9515 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9516 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9517 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9518 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9519 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9520 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9521 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9522 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9523 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9527 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9528 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9529 lines) may be present.
9531 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9532 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9535 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9536 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9537 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9540 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9541 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9542 are multiple headers with a given name.
9543 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9544 list-processing facilities can be used.
9545 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9546 the content is &"raw"&.
9549 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9550 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9551 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9552 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9553 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9554 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9555 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9556 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9559 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9560 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9561 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9562 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9563 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9564 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9567 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9568 command of the following form:
9570 headers charset "UTF-8"
9572 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9573 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9574 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9575 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9576 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9579 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9580 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9581 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9582 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9584 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9585 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9586 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9587 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9588 router or transport are not accessible.
9590 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9591 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9592 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9593 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9594 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9595 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9596 point they are added.
9597 When any of the above ACLs ar
9598 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9600 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9601 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9602 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9603 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9604 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9605 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9606 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9609 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9610 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9611 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9612 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9613 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9614 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9615 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9616 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9619 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9620 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9622 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9623 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9624 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9625 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9626 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9627 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9628 present. For example:
9630 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9632 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9635 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9637 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9638 an Exim configuration:
9640 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9642 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9645 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9646 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9647 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9649 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9650 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9651 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9652 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9653 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9654 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9657 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9658 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9659 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9660 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9661 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9662 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9664 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9666 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9667 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9668 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9669 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9670 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9672 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9673 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9674 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9676 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9680 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9685 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9686 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9687 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9688 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9689 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9690 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9694 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9695 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9696 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9697 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9698 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9699 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9700 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9703 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9705 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9706 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9707 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9708 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9711 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9712 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9713 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9714 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9715 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9716 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9717 apart from an optional leading minus,
9718 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9720 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9721 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9723 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9724 If the number is negative, the fields are
9725 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9726 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9727 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9729 If the modulus of the
9730 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9731 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9735 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9739 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9741 yields &"result: 42"&.
9743 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9744 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9746 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9749 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9750 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9751 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9752 described in the next item.
9754 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9755 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9756 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9757 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9758 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9759 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9760 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9761 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9762 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9764 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9765 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9766 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9767 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9768 out by the system administrator.
9771 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9772 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9773 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9774 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9775 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9776 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9777 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9778 original lookup fails.
9780 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9781 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9782 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9783 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9784 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9785 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9786 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9787 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9789 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9790 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9791 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9792 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9794 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9795 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9796 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9797 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9799 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9801 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9803 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9804 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9806 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9811 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9812 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9814 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9815 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9816 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9817 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9818 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9819 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9821 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9823 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9824 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9825 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9827 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9828 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9829 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9830 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9831 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9832 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9833 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9835 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9837 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9838 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9839 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9840 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9843 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9845 returns the string &"6/33"&.
9849 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9850 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9851 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9852 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9853 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9854 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9855 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9856 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9858 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9859 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9860 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9861 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9862 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9865 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9866 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9867 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9869 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9870 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9873 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9874 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9875 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9876 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9877 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9878 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9879 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9880 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9882 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9883 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9884 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9885 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9886 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9887 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9888 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9889 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9890 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9891 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9893 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9894 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9895 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9896 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9898 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9899 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9900 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9901 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9902 is the expansion of the third argument.
9904 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9905 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9906 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9908 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9909 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9910 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9911 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9912 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9913 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9914 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9915 newlines are left in the string.
9916 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9917 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9918 the string expansion fails.
9920 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9921 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9925 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9926 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9927 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9928 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9929 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9930 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9931 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9934 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9935 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9937 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9938 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9939 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9940 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9941 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9944 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9946 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9947 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9948 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9949 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9950 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9951 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9952 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9954 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9957 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9958 and must be present if the argument is given.
9959 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9960 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
9961 The first defines whether (the default)
9962 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9963 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9965 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9968 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
9970 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
9972 The default is to not use TLS.
9973 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
9976 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9977 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9978 turns them into spaces:
9980 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9982 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9983 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9984 addition, the following errors can occur:
9987 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9989 Failure to connect the socket;
9991 Failure to write the request string;
9993 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9996 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9997 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9998 errors occurs. For example:
10000 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10003 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10004 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10005 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10006 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10007 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10009 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10010 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10013 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10014 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10015 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10016 .vindex "&$value$&"
10018 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10019 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10020 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10021 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10022 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10023 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10024 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10025 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10026 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10028 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10030 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10033 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10035 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10036 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10039 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10040 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10041 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10043 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10044 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10045 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10046 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10047 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10048 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10049 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10050 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10051 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10053 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10054 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10055 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10056 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10057 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10058 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10059 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10060 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10061 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10064 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10065 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10066 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10067 .vindex "&$value$&"
10068 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10069 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10070 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10071 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10072 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10075 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10076 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10077 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10078 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10080 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10081 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10082 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10085 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10086 log_message = Output of id: $value
10088 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10089 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10091 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10094 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10095 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10096 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10098 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10099 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10103 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10104 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10107 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10108 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10109 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10110 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10112 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10113 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10116 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10117 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10118 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10119 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10120 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10121 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10122 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10123 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10125 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10127 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10128 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10129 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10131 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10133 yields &"defabc"&, and
10135 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10137 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10138 the regular expression from string expansion.
10140 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10141 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10144 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10145 .cindex sorting "a list"
10146 .cindex list sorting
10147 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10148 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10149 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10150 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10151 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10152 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10153 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10154 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10155 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10156 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10157 to give values for comparison.
10159 The item result is a sorted list,
10160 with the original list separator,
10161 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10165 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10167 sorts a list of numbers, and
10169 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10171 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10174 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10175 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10176 .cindex "substring extraction"
10177 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10178 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10179 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10180 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10181 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10183 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10185 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10186 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10189 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10190 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10191 length required. For example
10193 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10195 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10196 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10197 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10198 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10200 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10201 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10202 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10204 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10206 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10207 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10208 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10210 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10212 yields an empty string, but
10214 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10218 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10219 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10220 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10221 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10224 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10226 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10228 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10232 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10233 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10234 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10235 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10236 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10237 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10238 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10239 replacement list. For example
10241 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10243 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10244 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10245 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10248 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10254 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10255 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10256 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10257 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10258 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10259 following operations can be performed:
10262 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10263 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10264 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10265 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10266 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10267 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10269 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10272 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10273 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10274 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10275 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10276 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10277 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10278 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10279 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10280 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10282 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10283 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10284 character. For example:
10286 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10288 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10289 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10290 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10291 separator explicitly:
10293 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10296 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10297 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10298 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10301 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10302 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10303 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10304 email address separator. For the example header line:
10306 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10308 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10309 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10310 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10311 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10312 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10313 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10314 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10316 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10317 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10319 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10320 Last:user@example.com
10321 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10323 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10327 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10328 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10329 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10330 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10331 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10332 Only lowercase letters are used.
10334 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10335 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10336 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10337 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10338 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10340 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10341 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10342 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10343 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10344 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10345 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10346 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10347 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10348 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10350 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10351 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10352 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10353 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10354 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10355 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10358 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10359 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10360 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10361 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10362 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10363 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10365 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10366 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10369 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10370 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10371 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10372 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10373 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10376 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10377 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10378 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10379 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10380 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10383 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10384 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10385 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10386 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10387 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10388 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10389 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10391 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10392 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10393 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10394 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10395 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10396 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10399 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10400 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10401 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10402 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10403 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10404 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10405 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10406 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10407 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10408 C programming language):
10410 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10411 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10412 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10413 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10414 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10416 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10418 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10419 space is permitted before or after operators.
10421 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10422 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10423 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10424 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10425 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10427 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10429 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10430 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10433 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10434 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10435 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10436 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10437 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10438 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10439 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10440 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10441 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10442 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10443 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10446 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10448 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10451 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10454 {$recipients_count} \
10455 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10459 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10460 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10463 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10464 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10465 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10468 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10470 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10471 and then re-expands what it has found.
10474 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10476 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10477 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10478 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10479 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10480 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10481 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10482 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10483 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10484 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10486 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10487 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10488 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10489 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10490 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10491 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10492 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10495 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10496 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10497 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10498 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10499 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10500 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10502 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10504 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10505 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10509 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10510 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10511 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10512 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10513 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10514 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10518 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10519 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10520 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10521 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10522 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10523 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10524 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10527 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10528 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10529 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10530 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10531 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10532 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10533 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10535 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10536 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10537 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10538 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10539 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10540 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10541 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10542 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10543 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10546 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10547 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10548 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10549 .cindex "lower casing"
10550 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10551 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10552 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10556 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10558 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10559 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10560 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10561 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10562 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10563 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10565 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10567 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10568 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10569 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10570 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10573 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10574 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10575 .cindex "list" "item count"
10576 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10577 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10578 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10581 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10582 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10583 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10584 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10585 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10586 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10587 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10588 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10589 matching list is returned.
10592 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10593 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10594 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10595 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10596 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10598 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10601 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10602 .cindex "masked IP address"
10603 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10604 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10605 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10606 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10607 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10608 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10609 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10610 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10611 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10613 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10615 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10616 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10617 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10618 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10620 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10624 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10626 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10629 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10631 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10632 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10633 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10634 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10635 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10637 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10638 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10641 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10642 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10643 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10644 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10645 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10646 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10648 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10650 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10653 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10654 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10655 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10656 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10657 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10658 is an empty string or
10659 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10660 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10661 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10662 respectively For example,
10670 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10671 variable or a message header.
10673 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10674 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10675 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10676 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10677 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10678 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10679 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10681 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10682 will likely use the quoting form.
10683 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10686 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10687 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10688 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10689 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10690 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10692 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10698 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10699 yields an unchanged string.
10702 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10703 .cindex "random number"
10704 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10705 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10706 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10707 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10708 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10709 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10710 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10711 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10715 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10716 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10717 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10718 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10719 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10720 for DNS. For example,
10722 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10723 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10728 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10732 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10733 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10734 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10735 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10736 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10737 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10738 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10739 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10740 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10743 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10745 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10746 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10750 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10751 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10752 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10753 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10754 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10755 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10756 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10757 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10759 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10760 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10761 to use this operator as well.
10765 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10766 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10767 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10768 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10769 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10770 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10771 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10774 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10775 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10776 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10777 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10778 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10779 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10780 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10782 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10783 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10786 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10787 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10788 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10789 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10790 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10791 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10793 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10795 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10796 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10799 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10800 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10801 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10802 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10803 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10804 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10806 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10808 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10809 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10810 with 256 being the default.
10812 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10813 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10814 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10815 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10818 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10819 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10820 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10821 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10822 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10823 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10824 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10825 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10826 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10827 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10828 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10829 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10830 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10832 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10833 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10834 systems for files larger than 2GB.
10836 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10837 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10838 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10842 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10843 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
10844 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10845 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10846 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10847 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10848 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10851 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10852 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10853 .cindex "substring extraction"
10854 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10855 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10856 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10857 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10859 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10861 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10862 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10863 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10865 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10866 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10867 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10868 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10871 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10872 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10873 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10874 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10875 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10876 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10879 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10880 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10881 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10882 .cindex "upper casing"
10883 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10884 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10885 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10886 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10888 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10889 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10890 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10891 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10892 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10893 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10894 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10896 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
10897 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
10898 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
10899 the complexity will depend upon the task.
10900 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
10901 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
10902 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
10904 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
10906 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
10907 literal question mark).
10910 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10911 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10912 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10913 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10914 .cindex expansion UTF-8
10915 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
10917 .cindex internationalisation
10918 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10919 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10920 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10921 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10922 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10923 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10931 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10932 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10933 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10934 while expanding strings:
10937 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10938 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10939 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10940 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10943 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10944 .cindex "numeric comparison"
10945 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10946 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10952 &`>= `& greater or equal
10954 &`<= `& less or equal
10958 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10960 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10961 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10962 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10963 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10964 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10967 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10968 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
10969 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10972 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10973 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10974 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10975 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10976 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10977 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10978 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10979 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10980 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10981 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10982 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10983 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10984 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10985 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10987 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10988 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10989 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10990 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10991 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10992 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10994 An empty string is treated as false.
10995 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10996 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10997 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10999 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11000 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11003 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11007 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11008 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11009 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11010 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11011 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11012 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11013 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11014 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11016 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11018 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11019 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11020 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11021 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11022 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11023 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11024 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11025 included in the binary.
11027 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11028 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11029 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11030 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11031 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11032 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11033 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11034 string in LDAP form is:
11036 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11038 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11039 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11041 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11043 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11048 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11049 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11050 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11051 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11052 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11053 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11057 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11058 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11059 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11060 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11061 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11062 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11065 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11066 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11067 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11068 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11069 whatever its length.
11072 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11073 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11074 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11075 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11077 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11078 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11079 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11080 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11081 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11082 support &[crypt16()]&.
11084 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11085 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11086 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11087 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11088 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11090 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11091 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11092 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11094 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11095 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11096 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11097 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11098 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11100 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11101 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11102 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11103 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11104 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11105 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11107 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11109 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11110 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11112 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11113 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11114 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11115 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11116 exists in the message. For example,
11118 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11120 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11121 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11123 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11124 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11125 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11126 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11127 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11128 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11129 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11130 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11131 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11132 case is defined per the system C locale.
11134 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11135 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11136 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11137 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11138 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11139 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11140 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11141 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11143 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11144 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11145 .cindex "first delivery"
11146 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11147 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11148 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11149 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11152 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11153 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11154 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11155 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11156 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11158 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11159 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11160 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11161 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11162 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11164 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11165 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11166 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11168 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11169 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11170 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11172 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11173 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11174 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11175 list separator is changed to a comma:
11177 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11179 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11180 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11182 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11185 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11186 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11187 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11188 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11189 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11190 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11191 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11192 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11193 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11195 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11197 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11198 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11199 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11200 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11201 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11202 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11203 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11204 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11205 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11207 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11209 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11210 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11211 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11212 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11213 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11214 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11216 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11218 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11219 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11221 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11222 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11223 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11224 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11227 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11228 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11229 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11230 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11231 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11232 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11233 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11234 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11235 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11236 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11237 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11239 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11240 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11241 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11242 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11243 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11245 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11246 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11248 This is no longer the case.
11250 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11251 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11253 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11255 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11257 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11258 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11259 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11260 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11261 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11262 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11263 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11264 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11265 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11266 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11267 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11268 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11269 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11273 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11274 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11275 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11276 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11277 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11278 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11279 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11280 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11281 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11283 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11285 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11286 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11287 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11288 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11289 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11290 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11291 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11292 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11293 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11295 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11298 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11299 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11300 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11301 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11302 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11303 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11304 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11305 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11306 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11307 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11308 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11311 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11313 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11314 backslashes is also required.
11316 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11317 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11318 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11319 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11320 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11321 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11322 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11323 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11325 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11326 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11327 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11328 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11329 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11330 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11331 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11332 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11334 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11335 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11336 See &*match_local_part*&.
11338 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11339 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11340 See &*match_local_part*&.
11342 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11343 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11344 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11345 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11346 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11347 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11349 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11351 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11354 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11356 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11358 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11359 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11360 in a single test such as
11361 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11362 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11363 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11364 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11366 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11368 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11370 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11372 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11373 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11374 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11375 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11376 masks. For example:
11378 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11380 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11381 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11382 address mask, for example:
11384 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11386 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11387 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11389 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11393 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11394 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11396 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11398 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11399 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11400 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11401 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11402 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11403 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11404 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11405 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11408 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11410 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11411 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11412 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11413 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11415 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11417 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11418 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11419 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11420 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11423 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11424 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11426 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11427 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11428 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11429 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11431 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11432 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11433 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11434 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11435 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11436 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11437 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11438 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11439 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11440 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11441 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11445 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11446 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11448 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11449 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11450 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11451 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11452 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11453 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11454 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11456 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11457 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11458 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11459 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11460 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11462 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11464 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11466 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11468 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11469 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11470 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11471 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11474 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11475 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11477 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11478 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11479 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11480 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11481 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11482 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11484 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11485 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11486 building Exim. For example:
11488 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11490 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11491 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11492 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11493 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11495 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11496 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11497 configuration, you might have this:
11499 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11501 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11503 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11505 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11506 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11507 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11508 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11509 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11510 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11513 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11515 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11516 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11517 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11518 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11519 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11522 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11523 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11524 this library, you need to set
11526 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11528 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11529 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11531 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11533 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11534 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11535 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11537 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11538 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11539 the authentication is successful. For example:
11541 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11545 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11546 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11547 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11549 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11550 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11551 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11552 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11553 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11554 by a process that is not running as root.
11556 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11557 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11558 building Exim. For example:
11560 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11562 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11563 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11564 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11566 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11567 two are mandatory. For example:
11569 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11571 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11572 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11573 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11578 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11579 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11580 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11581 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11582 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11583 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11584 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11588 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11589 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11590 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11591 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11592 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11595 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11597 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11598 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11599 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11601 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11602 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11603 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11604 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11605 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11606 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11607 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11608 parsed but not evaluated.
11610 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11615 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11616 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11617 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11618 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11619 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11622 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11623 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11624 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11625 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11626 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11627 In the expansion condition case
11628 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11629 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11630 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11631 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11632 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11633 matching condition.
11635 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11636 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11637 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11638 any unused variables being made empty.
11640 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11641 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11642 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11643 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11644 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11645 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11646 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11647 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11648 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11649 during subsequent delivery.
11651 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11652 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11653 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11654 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11655 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11656 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11657 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11658 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11661 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11662 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11663 this variable has the number of arguments.
11665 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11666 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11667 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11668 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11669 be preserved by coding like this:
11671 warn !verify = sender
11672 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11674 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11675 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11678 .vitem &$address_data$&
11679 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11680 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11681 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11682 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11683 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11684 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11687 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11688 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11689 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11690 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11691 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11692 from the child's routing.
11694 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11695 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11696 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11699 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11700 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11701 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11703 .vitem &$address_file$&
11704 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11705 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11706 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11707 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11708 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11710 /home/r2d2/savemail
11712 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11713 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11714 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11715 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11716 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11717 to the relevant file.
11719 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11720 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11721 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11722 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11724 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11725 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11726 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11727 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11729 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11730 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11731 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11732 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11733 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11734 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11735 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11736 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11737 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11739 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11740 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11741 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11742 command line option.
11743 This second case also sets up information used by the
11744 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11746 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11747 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11748 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11749 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11750 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11751 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11752 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11753 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11754 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11758 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11759 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11760 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11761 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11762 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11763 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11764 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11765 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11766 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11767 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11768 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11770 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11771 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11772 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11773 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11774 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11777 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11778 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11779 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11780 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11781 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11782 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11783 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11784 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11785 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11786 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11787 an undefined mechanism.
11789 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11790 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11791 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11792 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11793 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11794 the ACL malware condition.
11796 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11797 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11798 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11799 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11800 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11801 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11803 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11804 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11805 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11806 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11807 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11808 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11809 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11811 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11812 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11813 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11814 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11815 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11817 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11818 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11819 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11820 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11821 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11823 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
11824 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11825 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11826 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11827 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11828 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11829 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11831 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
11832 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11833 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11834 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11835 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11836 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11837 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11839 .vitem &$callout_address$&
11840 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11841 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11842 address that was connected to.
11844 .vitem &$compile_number$&
11845 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11846 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11847 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11848 compilations of the same version of the program.
11850 .vitem &$config_dir$&
11851 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11852 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11853 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11854 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11855 &$config_dir$& is ".".
11857 .vitem &$config_file$&
11858 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
11859 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11861 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11862 Results of DKIM verification.
11863 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11865 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11866 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11867 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11868 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11869 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11871 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11872 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11873 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11874 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11875 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11876 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11877 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11878 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11879 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11880 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11881 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11882 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11883 &$dkim_key_length$&
11884 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11885 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11887 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11888 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11889 When a message has been received this variable contains
11890 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11891 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11893 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11894 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11895 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11897 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11898 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11899 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11900 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11901 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
11902 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11903 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11904 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11905 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11908 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11909 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11910 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11911 case for &$domain$&.
11913 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11914 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11915 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11916 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11918 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11919 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11920 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11921 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11922 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11923 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11925 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11926 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11927 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11929 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11932 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11933 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11934 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11935 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11936 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11937 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11938 the &(smtp)& transport.
11941 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11942 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11943 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11944 rewrite domains by file lookup.
11947 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11948 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11949 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11950 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11951 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11952 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11955 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11956 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11957 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11958 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11962 .vitem &$domain_data$&
11963 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11964 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11965 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11966 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11967 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11968 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11971 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11972 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11973 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11976 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
11977 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11978 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11980 .vitem &$exim_path$&
11981 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11982 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11984 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
11985 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11986 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11988 .vitem &$exim_version$&
11989 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11990 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11991 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11992 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11993 There may be other characters following the minor version.
11995 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11996 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11997 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11998 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11999 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12000 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12002 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12003 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12004 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12005 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12006 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12010 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12011 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12012 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12013 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12014 by a setting on the transport itself.
12016 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12017 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12018 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12022 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12023 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12024 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12025 to local and remote transports.
12027 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12028 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12029 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12030 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12031 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12032 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12033 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12036 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12037 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12038 client is connected.
12041 .vitem &$host_address$&
12042 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12043 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12044 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12045 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12047 .vitem &$host_data$&
12048 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12049 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12050 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12051 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12053 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12054 message = $host_data
12056 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12057 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12058 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12059 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12060 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12061 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12062 variables is set to &"1"&.
12065 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12066 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12069 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12070 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12071 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12074 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12075 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12076 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12077 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12078 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12079 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12080 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12081 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12082 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12083 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12085 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12086 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12087 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12090 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12091 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12092 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12094 .vitem &$host_port$&
12095 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12096 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12097 for an outbound connection.
12099 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12100 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12101 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12102 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12103 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12104 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12107 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12108 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12109 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12110 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12111 a unique name for the file.
12113 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12114 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12115 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12117 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12118 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12119 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12123 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12124 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12125 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12129 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12130 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12131 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12134 .vitem &$load_average$&
12135 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12136 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12137 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12138 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12140 .vitem &$local_part$&
12141 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12142 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12143 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12144 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12145 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12147 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12148 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12149 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12150 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12153 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12154 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12155 .cindex affix variables
12156 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12157 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12158 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12159 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12161 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12162 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12163 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12166 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12167 local part of the recipient address.
12169 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12170 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12171 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12173 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12176 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12177 abc\:xyz@test.example
12179 the value of &$local_part$& is
12183 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12184 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12187 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12189 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12190 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12191 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12193 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12194 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12195 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12196 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12197 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12198 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12199 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12201 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12202 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12203 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12204 variable expands to nothing.
12206 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12207 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12208 .cindex affix variables
12209 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12210 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12211 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12213 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12214 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12215 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12216 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12217 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12219 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12220 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12221 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12222 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12224 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12225 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12226 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12228 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12229 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12230 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12231 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12232 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12233 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12234 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12235 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12237 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12238 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12239 This contains the expanded value of the
12240 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12243 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12244 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12245 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12246 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12247 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12248 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12250 .vitem &$log_space$&
12251 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12252 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12253 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12254 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12255 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12256 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12259 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12260 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12261 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12262 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12263 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12264 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12265 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12266 and &"yes"& if it was.
12267 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12268 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12269 as authenticated data.
12271 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12272 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12273 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12274 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12275 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12276 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12277 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12280 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12281 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12282 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12283 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12284 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12286 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12287 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12288 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12289 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12290 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12291 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12293 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12295 .vitem &$message_age$&
12296 .cindex "message" "age of"
12297 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12298 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12299 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12302 .vitem &$message_body$&
12303 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12304 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12305 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12306 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12307 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12308 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12309 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12310 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12311 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12313 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12314 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12315 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12316 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12317 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12319 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12320 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12321 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12322 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12323 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12324 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12327 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12328 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12329 .cindex "message body" "size"
12330 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12331 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12332 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12333 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12334 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12336 If the spool file is wireformat
12337 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12338 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12340 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12341 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12342 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12343 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12344 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12345 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12346 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12347 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12349 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12350 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12351 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12352 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12353 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12354 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12356 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12357 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12358 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12359 contents of header lines is done.
12361 .vitem &$message_id$&
12362 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12364 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12365 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12366 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12367 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12368 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12369 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12370 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12371 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12372 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12373 from the body is not counted.
12375 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12376 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12377 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12378 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12379 header and the body).
12381 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12383 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12385 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12387 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12388 message has not yet been received.
12390 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12392 .vitem &$message_size$&
12393 .cindex "size" "of message"
12394 .cindex "message" "size"
12395 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12396 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12397 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12398 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12399 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12400 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12401 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12402 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12403 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12405 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12406 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12407 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12408 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12410 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12411 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12412 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12413 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12415 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12416 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12417 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12419 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12420 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12421 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12422 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12423 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12424 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12425 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12426 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12427 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12428 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12430 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12431 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12432 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12434 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12435 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12436 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12437 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12438 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12439 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12440 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12441 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12442 the original address.
12444 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12445 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12446 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12447 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12448 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12450 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12451 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12452 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12454 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12455 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12456 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12457 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12458 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12459 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12460 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12461 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12462 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12464 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12465 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12466 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12467 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12468 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12469 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12470 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12471 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12474 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12475 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12476 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12477 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12479 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12480 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12481 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12482 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12485 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12487 This variable contains the current process id.
12489 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12490 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12491 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12492 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12493 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12494 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12495 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12496 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12497 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12498 variable"& error if encountered.
12500 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12501 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12502 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12503 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12504 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12505 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12506 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12509 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12510 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12511 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12512 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12514 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12516 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12518 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12519 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12520 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12521 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12523 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12524 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12525 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12526 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12528 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12529 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12530 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12531 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12533 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12534 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12535 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12536 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12538 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12539 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12540 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12542 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12543 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12544 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12545 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12547 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12548 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12549 .cindex "named queues"
12550 .cindex queues named
12551 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12553 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12554 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12555 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12556 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12557 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12559 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12560 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12561 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12562 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12563 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12564 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12566 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12567 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12568 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12569 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12570 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12572 .vitem &$received_count$&
12573 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12574 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12575 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12576 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12579 .vitem &$received_for$&
12580 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12581 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12582 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12583 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12584 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12586 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12587 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12588 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12589 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12590 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12591 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12592 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12595 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12596 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12597 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12598 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12599 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12601 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12603 .vitem &$received_port$&
12604 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12605 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12607 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12608 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12609 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12610 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12611 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12612 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12613 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12614 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12615 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12617 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12618 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12619 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12620 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12621 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12622 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12624 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12625 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12626 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12628 .vitem &$received_time$&
12629 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12630 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12631 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12633 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12634 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12635 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12636 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12637 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12639 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12640 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12642 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12643 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12644 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12645 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12647 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12648 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12649 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12650 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12653 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12654 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12657 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12660 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12661 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12665 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12668 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12671 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12672 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12674 .vitem &$recipients$&
12675 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12676 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12677 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12678 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12679 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12683 In a system filter file.
12685 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12686 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12687 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12688 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12690 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12694 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12695 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12696 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12697 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12698 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12699 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12702 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12703 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12704 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12705 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12707 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12708 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12709 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12710 these variables contain the
12711 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12714 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12715 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12716 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12717 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12718 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12719 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12720 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12722 .vitem &$return_path$&
12723 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12724 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12725 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12726 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12727 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12728 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12729 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12730 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12731 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12732 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12735 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12736 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12737 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12739 .vitem &$router_name$&
12740 .cindex "router" "name"
12741 .cindex "name" "of router"
12742 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12743 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12746 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12747 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12748 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12749 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12750 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12751 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12752 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12755 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12756 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12757 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12758 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12759 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12760 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12761 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12762 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12764 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12765 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12766 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12767 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12768 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12769 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12771 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12772 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12773 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12774 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12775 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12776 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12777 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12778 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12780 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12781 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12782 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12784 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12785 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12786 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12788 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12789 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12790 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12791 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12792 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12795 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12796 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12798 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12799 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12800 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12801 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12803 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12804 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12805 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12806 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12807 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12808 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12809 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12810 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12811 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12812 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12813 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12814 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12815 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12817 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12818 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12819 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12820 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12821 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12823 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12824 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12825 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12826 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12827 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12828 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12830 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12831 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12832 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12833 this variable contains that
12834 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12836 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12837 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12838 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12839 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12840 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12841 &$authenticated_id$&.
12843 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12844 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12845 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12846 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12847 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12848 resolver library states that both
12849 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12850 other times, this variable is false.
12852 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12853 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12854 library, by setting:
12859 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12860 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12862 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12863 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12865 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12866 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12867 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12868 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12871 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12872 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12873 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12874 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12875 other means, this variable is empty.
12877 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12878 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12879 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12880 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12881 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12882 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12883 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12885 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12886 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12887 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12888 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12890 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12891 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12892 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12895 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12896 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12897 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12898 following are true:
12901 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12903 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12904 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12905 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12907 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12908 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12909 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12911 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12912 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12913 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12915 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12916 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12917 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12918 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12920 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12922 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12923 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12927 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12928 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12929 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12930 number that was used on the remote host.
12932 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
12933 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12934 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12935 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12936 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12939 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12940 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12941 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12942 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12944 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12945 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12946 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12947 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12948 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12949 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12950 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12951 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12952 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12953 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12954 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12957 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12958 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12959 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12960 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12961 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12963 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12964 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12965 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12966 about the failure. The details are the same as for
12967 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12969 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12970 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12971 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12972 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12973 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12974 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12975 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12977 .vitem &$sending_port$&
12978 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12979 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12980 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12981 connections, see &$received_port$&.
12983 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12984 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12985 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12986 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12987 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12988 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12990 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
12991 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12992 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12993 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12994 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12999 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13000 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13001 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13002 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13004 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13005 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13006 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13007 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13008 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13009 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13010 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13012 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13013 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13014 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13015 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13016 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13019 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13020 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13021 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13022 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13023 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13024 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13025 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13026 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13027 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13028 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13029 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13031 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13032 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13033 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13034 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13035 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13036 message is junk mail.
13038 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13039 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13040 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13041 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13043 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13044 &$spf_received$& &&&
13046 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13047 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13048 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13049 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13051 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13052 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13053 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13055 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13056 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13057 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13058 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13059 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13060 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13062 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13063 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13064 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13065 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13066 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13067 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13068 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13069 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13071 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13073 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13076 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13077 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13078 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13079 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13080 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13081 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13083 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13084 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13085 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13086 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13087 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13088 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13089 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13090 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13092 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13093 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13096 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13097 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13098 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13099 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13100 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13101 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13103 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13104 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13105 .cindex certificate variables
13106 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13107 inbound connection when the message was received.
13108 It is only useful as the argument of a
13109 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13110 or a &%def%& condition.
13112 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13113 when a list of more than one
13114 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13116 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13117 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13118 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13119 inbound connection when the message was received.
13120 It is only useful as the argument of a
13121 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13122 or a &%def%& condition.
13123 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13124 which is not the leaf.
13126 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13127 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13128 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13129 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13130 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13131 or a &%def%& condition.
13133 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13134 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13135 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13136 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13137 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13138 or a &%def%& condition.
13139 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13140 which is not the leaf.
13142 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13143 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13144 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13145 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13147 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13148 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13151 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13152 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13153 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13154 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13155 and &"0"& otherwise.
13157 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13158 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13159 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13160 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13161 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13162 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13163 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13164 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13165 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13167 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13168 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13169 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13171 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13172 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13174 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13175 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13176 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13177 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13179 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13180 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13181 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13183 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13184 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13185 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13186 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13188 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13189 1 No response to request
13190 2 Response not verified
13191 3 Verification failed
13192 4 Verification succeeded
13195 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13196 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13197 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13198 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13199 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13201 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13202 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13203 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13204 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13205 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13206 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13207 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13208 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13209 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13210 which is not the leaf.
13212 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13213 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13216 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13217 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13218 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13219 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13220 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13221 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13222 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13223 which is not the leaf.
13225 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13226 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13227 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13228 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13229 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13230 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13231 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13232 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13233 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13234 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13235 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13237 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13238 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13241 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13242 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13243 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13245 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13248 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13249 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13250 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13252 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13253 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13254 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13255 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13257 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13258 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13259 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13261 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13262 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13263 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13265 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13266 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13267 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13268 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13269 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13270 values for those that are behind (west).
13273 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13274 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13275 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13277 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13278 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13279 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13280 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13283 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13284 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13285 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13288 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13289 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13290 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13291 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13293 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13294 .cindex "transport" "name"
13295 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13296 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13297 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13300 .vindex "&$value$&"
13301 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13302 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13303 &*reduce*& expansion.
13305 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13306 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13307 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13308 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13311 .vitem &$version_number$&
13312 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13313 The version number of Exim.
13315 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13316 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13317 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13318 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13320 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13321 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13322 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13323 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13329 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13332 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13333 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13334 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13335 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13336 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13337 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13342 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13345 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13346 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13347 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13348 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13349 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13350 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13351 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13352 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13353 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13355 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13356 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13357 should usually be something like
13359 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13361 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13362 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13363 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13364 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13365 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13366 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13367 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13368 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13372 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13373 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13374 a startup when Exim is entered.
13376 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13377 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13380 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13381 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13384 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13385 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13386 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13387 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13388 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13389 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13393 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13394 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13395 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13396 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13400 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13401 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13403 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13404 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13405 with an error message of the form
13407 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13409 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13410 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13411 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13412 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13413 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13414 that was passed to &%die%&.
13417 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13418 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13419 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13422 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13424 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13425 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13426 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13428 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13429 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13430 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13431 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13433 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13434 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13435 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13436 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13437 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13438 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13439 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13442 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13443 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13444 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13445 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13446 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13447 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13448 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13449 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13450 avoided, but the output is lost.
13452 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13453 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13454 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13455 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13456 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13457 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13458 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13460 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13462 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13463 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13464 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13465 as the first subroutine argument.
13469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13470 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13472 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13473 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13474 "Starting the daemon"
13475 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13476 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13477 .cindex "network interface"
13478 .cindex "interface" "network"
13479 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13480 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13481 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13482 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13483 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13484 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13485 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13486 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13487 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13488 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13489 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13492 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13493 and ports to listen on.
13495 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13496 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13497 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13498 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13499 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13500 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13501 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13502 as an error situation.
13504 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13505 for the outgoing connection.
13509 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13510 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13511 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13512 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13513 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13515 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13516 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13517 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13518 chapter describes how they operate.
13520 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13521 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13525 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13526 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13527 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13531 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13533 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13535 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13536 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13539 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13540 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13541 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13542 colons. For example:
13544 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13547 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13549 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13550 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13553 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13554 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13556 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13557 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13560 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13561 with a colon separator, for example:
13563 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13564 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13568 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13569 default setting contains just one port:
13571 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13573 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13574 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13575 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13576 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13577 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13581 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13582 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13583 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13584 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13585 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13586 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13588 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13590 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13592 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13594 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13598 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13599 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13600 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13601 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13602 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13603 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13606 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13607 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13608 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13609 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13610 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13611 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13615 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13618 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13620 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13621 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13622 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13626 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13627 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13628 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13629 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13630 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13631 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13632 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13633 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13634 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13635 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13636 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13637 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13638 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13641 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13642 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13643 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13645 The common use of this option is expected to be
13647 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13650 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13651 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13653 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13654 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13655 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13656 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13657 connections via the daemon.)
13662 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13663 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13664 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13665 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13666 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13667 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13668 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13669 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13671 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13673 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13674 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13675 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13676 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13677 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13678 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13680 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13682 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13683 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13684 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13685 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13686 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13688 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13689 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13690 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13691 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13692 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13693 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13694 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13695 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13696 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13697 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13698 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13699 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13701 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13702 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13703 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13704 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13705 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13709 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13710 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13712 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13713 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13715 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13716 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13717 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13718 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13720 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13722 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13724 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13726 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13727 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13729 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13730 IPv4 loopback address only:
13732 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13734 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13736 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13738 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13742 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13743 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13744 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13745 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13748 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13749 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13750 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13751 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13753 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13754 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13755 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13756 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13757 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13758 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13759 used for listening. Consider this example:
13761 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13763 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13765 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13767 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13768 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13771 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13772 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13773 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13774 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13775 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13776 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13777 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13778 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13782 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13783 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13784 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13785 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13786 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13787 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13796 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13797 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13798 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13799 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13802 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13803 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13805 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13806 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13807 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13809 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13810 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13811 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13812 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13816 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13817 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13818 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13819 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13820 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13821 listed in more than one group.
13823 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13825 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13826 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13827 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13828 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13829 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13830 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13831 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13832 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13833 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13834 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13835 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13839 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13841 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13842 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13843 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13844 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13845 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13846 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13851 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13853 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13854 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13855 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13856 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13857 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13858 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13859 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13860 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13861 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13862 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13863 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13864 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13869 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
13871 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13872 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13873 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13874 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13875 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13876 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13877 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13878 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13879 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13880 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13881 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13882 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13883 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13884 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13885 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13890 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13892 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13893 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13894 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13895 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13900 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13902 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13903 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13904 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13905 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13906 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13907 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13908 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13909 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13910 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13911 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13912 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13913 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13914 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13915 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13916 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13921 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13923 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13924 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13929 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13931 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13932 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13933 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13938 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13940 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13941 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13942 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13943 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13944 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13945 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13946 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13951 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13953 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13954 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13955 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13956 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13957 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13958 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13959 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13960 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13961 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13962 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13963 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13964 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13965 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13966 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13967 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13968 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13970 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13971 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13972 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13973 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13974 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13979 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13981 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13982 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13983 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13984 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13985 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13986 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13987 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13988 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13989 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13990 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13991 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13992 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13993 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13994 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13995 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13996 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13997 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13998 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13999 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14000 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14001 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14002 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14004 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14005 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14006 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14007 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14008 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14009 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14010 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14011 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14012 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14013 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14014 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14015 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14016 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14017 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14018 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14019 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14020 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14021 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14022 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14023 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14028 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14030 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14032 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14034 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14035 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14036 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14041 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14043 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14044 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14045 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14046 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14047 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14048 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14049 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14050 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14051 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14052 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14053 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14054 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14055 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14056 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14057 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14058 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14059 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14064 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14066 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14067 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14068 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14069 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14070 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14071 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14072 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14073 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14078 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14080 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14081 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14082 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14083 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14084 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14085 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14086 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14087 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14093 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14095 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14102 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14103 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14106 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14107 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14108 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14109 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14110 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14111 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14112 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14113 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14114 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14115 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14116 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14117 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14118 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14119 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14120 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14122 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14123 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14124 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14125 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14126 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14127 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14128 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14129 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14130 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14131 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14132 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14133 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14134 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14135 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14136 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14137 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14142 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14144 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14145 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14146 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14147 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14148 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14149 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14150 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14151 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14152 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14153 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14158 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14160 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14161 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14162 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14163 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14165 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14166 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14167 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14168 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14169 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14170 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14171 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14172 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14173 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14174 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14179 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14181 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14182 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14184 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14185 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14186 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14187 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14188 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14193 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14195 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14196 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14197 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14198 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14199 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14200 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14201 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14202 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14203 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14204 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14205 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14206 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14207 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14208 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14209 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14210 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14211 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14212 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14213 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14214 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14215 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14216 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14217 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14218 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14223 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14225 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14226 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14227 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14228 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14229 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14230 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14231 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14232 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14233 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14234 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14235 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14236 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14237 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14238 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14239 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14244 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14245 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14248 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14250 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14251 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14252 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14253 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14254 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14255 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14256 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14258 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14259 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14260 It now defaults to true.
14261 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14263 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14266 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14268 log_selector = +8bitmime
14271 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14272 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14273 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14274 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14275 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14278 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14279 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14280 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14283 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14284 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14285 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14286 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14287 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14289 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14290 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14291 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14292 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14293 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14295 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14296 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14297 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14298 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14300 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14301 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14302 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14303 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14304 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14306 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14307 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14308 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14309 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14310 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14311 This option defines the ACL that,
14312 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14313 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14314 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14315 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14317 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14318 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14319 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14320 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14321 of a received message.
14322 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14324 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14325 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14326 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14327 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14329 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14330 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14331 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14332 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14334 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14335 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14336 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14337 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14338 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14341 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14342 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14343 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14344 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14346 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14347 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14348 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14349 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14350 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14352 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14353 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14354 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14355 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14356 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14358 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14359 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14360 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14361 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14362 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14364 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14365 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14366 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14369 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14370 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14371 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14372 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14374 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14375 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14376 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14377 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14379 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14380 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14381 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14382 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14384 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14385 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14386 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14387 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14389 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14390 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14391 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14392 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14393 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14395 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14396 .cindex "admin user"
14397 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14398 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14399 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14400 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14401 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14402 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14403 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14405 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14406 .cindex "domain literal"
14407 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14408 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14409 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14410 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14412 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14413 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14414 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14415 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14416 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14417 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14418 the local host's IP addresses.
14421 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14422 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14423 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14424 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14425 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14426 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14427 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14428 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14429 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14431 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14432 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14433 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14434 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14435 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14436 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14437 experiment if they wish.
14439 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14440 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14441 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14442 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14443 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14444 suitable setting is:
14446 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14447 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14449 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14451 dns_check_names_pattern =
14453 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14456 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14457 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14458 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14459 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14460 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14461 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14462 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14463 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14464 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14465 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14466 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14468 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14469 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14470 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14471 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14472 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14473 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14475 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14476 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14477 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14478 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14480 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14482 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14483 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14484 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14485 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14488 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14489 .cindex "thawing messages"
14490 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14491 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14492 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14493 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14494 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14495 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14497 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14498 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14499 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14502 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14503 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14504 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14506 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14508 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14509 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14512 .option bi_command main string unset
14514 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14515 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14516 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14517 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14520 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14521 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14522 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14523 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14524 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14525 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14528 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14529 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14530 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14531 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14533 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14534 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14535 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14536 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14537 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14538 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14539 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14540 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14541 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14542 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14544 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14545 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14546 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14547 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14548 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14549 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14550 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14551 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14552 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14553 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14555 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14556 during reception of a message.
14557 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14559 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14562 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14563 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14564 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14565 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14568 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14569 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14570 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14571 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14572 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14573 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14574 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14575 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14576 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14578 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14579 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14580 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14581 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14582 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14585 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14586 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14587 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14588 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14589 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14590 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14591 connection. A typical setting might be:
14593 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14595 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14597 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14599 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14602 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14603 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14604 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14605 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14606 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14607 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14610 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14611 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14612 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14613 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14616 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14617 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14618 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14619 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14622 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14623 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14624 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14625 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14628 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14629 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14630 callout verification. The default value is
14632 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14634 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14637 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14638 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14641 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14642 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14644 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14645 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14646 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14647 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14648 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14649 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14650 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14651 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14652 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14653 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14656 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14657 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14660 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14661 .cindex "checking disk space"
14662 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14663 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14664 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14665 message is accepted.
14667 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14668 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14669 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14670 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14671 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14672 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14673 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14674 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14677 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14678 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14680 check_spool_space = 100M
14681 check_spool_inodes = 100
14683 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14684 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14687 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14688 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14689 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14691 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14692 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14693 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14694 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14695 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14696 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14698 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14699 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14700 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14702 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14703 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14704 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14706 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14707 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14708 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14709 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14711 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14712 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14713 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14714 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14716 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14718 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14719 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14720 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14721 administrative user.
14722 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14724 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14725 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14726 .cindex memory debugging
14727 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14728 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14729 it should normally be left as default.
14731 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14732 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14733 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14734 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14735 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14736 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14738 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14739 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14740 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14741 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14742 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14743 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14744 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14746 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14747 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14749 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14750 .cindex "warning of delay"
14751 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14752 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14753 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14754 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14755 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14756 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14757 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14758 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14761 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14763 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14764 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14765 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14766 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14770 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14771 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14773 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14775 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14776 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14777 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14779 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14780 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14781 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14782 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14783 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14784 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14785 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14786 not sent. The default is:
14788 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14789 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14790 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14791 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14794 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14795 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14796 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14797 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14799 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14800 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14801 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14802 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14803 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14804 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14805 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14806 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14808 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14809 .cindex "load average"
14810 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14811 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14812 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14813 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14814 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14817 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14818 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14819 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14820 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14821 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14822 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14823 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14824 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14826 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
14827 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14828 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14829 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14830 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14831 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14832 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14833 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14835 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14836 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14837 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14838 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14841 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14842 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14843 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14844 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14845 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14846 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14847 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14850 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14851 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14852 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14853 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14854 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14855 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14858 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14859 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14860 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14861 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14862 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14863 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14864 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14865 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14866 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14867 by a setting such as this:
14869 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14871 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14872 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14873 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14874 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14875 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14876 options are applied after this global option.
14878 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14879 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14880 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14881 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14882 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14883 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14884 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14885 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14886 value of this option. The default pattern is
14888 dns_check_names_pattern = \
14889 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14891 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14892 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14893 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14894 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14895 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14898 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14899 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14900 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14902 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14903 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14904 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14905 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14908 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
14909 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
14910 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
14911 not do it internally.
14912 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
14913 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
14915 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
14916 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
14917 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
14921 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14922 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14923 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14924 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14925 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14926 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14928 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14931 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14932 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14933 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14934 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14935 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14936 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14937 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14938 domain matches this list.
14940 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14941 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14942 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14945 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
14946 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14947 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14948 .cindex "DNS" timeout
14949 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14950 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14951 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14952 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14953 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14954 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14955 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14956 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14958 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14961 .option dns_retry main integer 0
14962 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14965 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14966 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14967 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14968 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14969 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14970 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14971 match with this expanded domain list.
14973 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14974 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14975 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14976 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14977 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14978 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14980 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14981 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14982 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14984 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14985 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14986 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14987 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14988 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14990 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14991 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14992 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14993 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14994 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14995 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14996 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14997 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15000 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15002 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15003 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15004 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15007 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15008 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15009 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15010 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15012 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15013 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15014 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15015 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15016 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15017 and accepted from, these hosts.
15018 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15019 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15020 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15021 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15024 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15025 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15026 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15027 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15028 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15029 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15031 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15033 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15034 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15036 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15037 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15038 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15039 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15040 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15041 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15042 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15043 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15044 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15047 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15048 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15049 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15050 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15051 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15052 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15053 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15054 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15055 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15057 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15058 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15059 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15060 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15061 are examined. For example:
15063 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15064 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15065 postmaster@mydomain.example
15067 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15068 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15069 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15070 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15071 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15072 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15073 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15076 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15077 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15078 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15080 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15082 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15083 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15084 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15085 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15086 overrides the default.
15088 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15089 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15090 and warning messages. For example:
15092 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15094 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15095 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15096 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15097 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15101 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15103 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15104 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15107 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15108 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15109 .cindex "Exim group"
15110 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15111 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15112 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15113 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15114 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15118 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15119 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15120 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15121 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15122 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15123 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15125 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15126 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15127 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15128 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15131 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15132 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15133 .cindex "Exim user"
15134 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15135 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15136 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15137 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15139 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15140 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15141 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15142 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15145 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15146 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15147 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15148 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15151 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15152 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15154 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15155 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15157 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15158 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15159 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15160 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15161 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15162 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15163 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15164 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15165 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15166 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15170 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15171 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15172 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15173 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15174 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15175 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15176 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15177 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15180 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15181 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15182 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15183 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15187 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15188 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15189 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15190 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15191 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15192 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15193 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15194 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15195 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15196 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15197 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15198 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15199 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15200 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15201 logging that you require.
15204 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15206 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15207 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15208 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15209 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15210 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15211 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15212 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15213 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15215 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15216 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15217 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15220 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15221 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15222 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15223 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15225 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15229 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15230 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15233 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15234 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15235 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15236 implementations of TLS.
15239 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15240 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15241 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15244 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15249 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15250 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15251 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15252 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15253 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15254 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15258 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15259 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15260 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15261 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15262 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15263 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15264 sections are rejected.
15267 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15268 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15269 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15270 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15271 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15272 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15273 zero means &"no limit"&.
15278 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15279 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15280 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15281 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15282 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15283 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15284 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15285 if you want to do semantic checking.
15286 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15290 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15291 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15292 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15293 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15294 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15295 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15296 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15298 helo_allow_chars = _
15300 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15303 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15304 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15305 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15306 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15307 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15308 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15309 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15313 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15314 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15315 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15316 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15317 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15318 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15319 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15320 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15321 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15322 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15323 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15324 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15326 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15327 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15328 EHLO command either:
15331 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15333 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15334 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15335 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15336 calling host address, or
15338 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15341 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15342 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15343 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15345 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15346 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15347 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15349 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15350 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15351 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15352 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15353 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15354 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15355 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15356 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15357 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15360 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15361 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15362 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15363 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15364 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15365 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15366 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15367 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15368 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15370 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15371 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15372 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15373 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15374 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15376 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15377 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15378 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15379 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15382 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15383 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15384 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15385 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15386 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15387 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15388 default configuration file contains
15392 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15393 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15395 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15396 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15397 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15399 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15400 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15401 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15402 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15403 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15404 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15407 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15408 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15409 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15410 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15411 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15414 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15415 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15416 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15417 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15421 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15422 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15423 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15424 as soon as the connection is made.
15425 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15426 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15427 connections immediately.
15429 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15430 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15431 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15432 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15433 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15436 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15437 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15438 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15439 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15440 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15441 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15442 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15443 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15444 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15446 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15448 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15452 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15453 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15454 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15455 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15458 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15459 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15460 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15461 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15462 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15464 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15465 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15467 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15468 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15469 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15470 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15471 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15472 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15473 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15476 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15477 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15478 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15479 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15480 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15484 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15485 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15486 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15487 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15488 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15489 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15491 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15492 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15493 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15494 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15495 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15496 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15497 for frozen messages. For example,
15499 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15501 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15502 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15503 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15504 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15505 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15506 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15509 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15510 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15511 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15512 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15513 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15514 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15515 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15516 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15517 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15518 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15521 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15522 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15524 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15525 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15526 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15527 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15528 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15529 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15530 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15531 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15532 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15534 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15535 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15537 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15538 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15539 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15540 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15542 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15543 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15544 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15547 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15548 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15549 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15553 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15554 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15555 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15556 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15560 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15561 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15562 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15563 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15564 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15565 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15566 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15567 and constrained to be a directory.
15570 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15571 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15572 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15573 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15574 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15575 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15576 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15577 and constrained to be a file.
15580 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15581 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15582 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15583 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15584 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15585 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15588 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15589 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15590 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15591 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15592 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15593 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15594 identity to be proven.
15597 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15598 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15599 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15600 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15601 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15604 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15605 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15606 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15607 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15608 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15612 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15613 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15614 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15615 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15616 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15617 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15621 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15622 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15623 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15624 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15625 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15627 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15628 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15629 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15632 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15633 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15634 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15635 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15636 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15637 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15638 has been built with LDAP support.
15642 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15643 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15644 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15645 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15646 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15647 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15648 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15650 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15651 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15652 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15654 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15655 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15656 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15657 and the default qualify domain.
15659 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15660 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15661 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15662 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15664 .cindex "envelope sender"
15665 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15666 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15667 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15669 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15670 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15671 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15676 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15677 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15678 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15679 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15680 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15681 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15682 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15685 local_from_prefix = *-
15687 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15689 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15691 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15692 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15696 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15697 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15700 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15701 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15702 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15703 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15704 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15705 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15706 &%local_interfaces%& is
15708 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15710 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15712 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15715 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15716 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15717 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15718 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15719 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15720 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15721 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15722 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15726 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15727 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15728 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15729 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15730 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15731 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15732 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15733 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15738 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15739 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15740 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15741 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15742 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15743 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15744 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15745 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15746 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15747 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15748 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15749 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15750 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15751 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15752 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15756 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15757 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15758 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15759 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15760 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15761 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15762 or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15763 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15764 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15765 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15766 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15767 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15768 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15769 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15770 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15773 .option log_selector main string unset
15774 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15775 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15776 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15777 minus characters. For example:
15779 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15781 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15782 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15785 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15786 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15787 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15788 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15789 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15790 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15791 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15792 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15793 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15794 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15795 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15796 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15797 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15800 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15801 .cindex "too many open files"
15802 .cindex "open files, too many"
15803 .cindex "file" "too many open"
15804 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15805 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15806 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15807 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15808 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15809 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15810 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15811 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15812 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15813 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15814 &%lookup_open_max%&.
15817 .option max_username_length main integer 0
15818 .cindex "length of login name"
15819 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15820 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
15821 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15822 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15823 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15824 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15827 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
15828 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15829 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15830 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15831 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15832 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15833 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15834 option is set true, this no longer happens.
15837 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
15838 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15839 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
15840 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
15841 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15842 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15843 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15846 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15847 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15848 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15849 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15850 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15851 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15852 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15853 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15854 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15855 empty string, the option is ignored.
15858 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15859 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15860 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15861 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15862 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15863 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15864 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15865 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15866 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15867 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15868 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15869 colons will become hyphens.
15872 .option message_logs main boolean true
15873 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15874 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15875 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15876 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15877 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15878 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15879 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15880 which is not affected by this option.
15883 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15884 .cindex "message" "size limit"
15885 .cindex "limit" "message size"
15886 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15887 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15888 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15889 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15890 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15891 optionally followed by K or M.
15893 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15894 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15895 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15896 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15897 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15899 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15900 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15901 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15902 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15903 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15904 message that an individual transport can process.
15906 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15907 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15908 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15909 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15910 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15911 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15912 some problems may result.
15914 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15915 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15916 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15919 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15920 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15921 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15923 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15925 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15926 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15927 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15928 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15929 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15932 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15933 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15934 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15935 contains a full description of this facility.
15939 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15940 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15941 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15942 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15943 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15946 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15947 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15948 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15949 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15950 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15953 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15954 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15955 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15956 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15957 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15959 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15960 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15963 never_users = root:daemon:bin
15965 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15966 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15970 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15971 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15972 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15973 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15974 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15976 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15977 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15978 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15979 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15980 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15981 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15982 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15984 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15985 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15986 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15987 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15988 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15990 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15992 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15993 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15994 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15995 some now infamous attacks.
15999 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16000 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16001 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16003 # Disable older protocol versions:
16004 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16007 Possible options may include:
16011 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16013 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16015 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16019 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16021 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16023 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16025 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16027 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16029 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16033 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16047 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16051 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16053 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16055 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16057 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16061 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16064 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16065 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16066 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16067 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16068 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16069 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16072 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16073 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16074 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16075 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16076 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16079 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16080 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16081 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16082 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16083 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16084 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16085 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16086 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16087 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16088 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16091 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16092 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16093 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16094 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16095 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16096 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16097 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16100 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16102 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16103 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16106 .option perl_startup main string unset
16108 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16109 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16111 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16113 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16116 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16117 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16118 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16119 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16120 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16121 PostgreSQL support.
16124 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16125 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16126 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16127 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16128 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16131 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16133 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16135 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16136 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16137 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16140 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16141 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16142 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16143 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16144 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16145 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16146 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16147 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16148 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16151 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16152 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16153 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16154 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16155 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16156 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16157 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16158 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16160 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16161 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16162 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16163 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16164 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16165 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16166 volume of mail. Use with care!
16169 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16170 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16171 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16172 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16173 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16174 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16175 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16176 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16177 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16178 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16180 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16181 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16182 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16183 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16184 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16185 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16188 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16189 .cindex "printing characters"
16190 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16191 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16192 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16193 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16194 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16195 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16198 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16199 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16200 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16201 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16202 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16206 .option process_log_path main string unset
16207 .cindex "process log path"
16208 .cindex "log" "process log"
16209 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16210 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16211 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16212 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16213 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16214 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16215 different spool directories.
16218 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16219 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16223 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16224 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16225 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16228 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16229 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16230 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16231 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16232 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16233 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16234 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16235 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16236 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16238 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16239 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16240 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16241 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16242 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16243 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16244 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16247 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16248 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16249 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16253 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16254 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16255 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16256 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16257 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16258 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16259 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16260 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16263 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16264 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16266 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16267 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16268 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16269 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16272 .option queue_only main boolean false
16273 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16274 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16275 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16276 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16277 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16278 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16280 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16281 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16282 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16283 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16286 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16287 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16288 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16289 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16290 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16291 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16292 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16293 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16294 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16296 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16298 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16299 &_/some/file_& exists.
16302 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16303 .cindex "load average"
16304 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16305 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16306 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16307 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16308 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16309 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16310 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16313 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16314 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16315 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16316 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16319 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16320 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16321 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16322 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16323 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16324 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16325 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16326 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16327 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16328 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16329 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16330 re-evaluated for each message.
16333 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16334 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16335 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16336 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16337 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16338 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16341 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16342 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16343 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16344 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16345 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16346 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16347 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16348 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16349 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16350 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16351 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16352 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16353 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16357 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16358 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16359 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16360 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16361 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16362 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16363 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16364 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16365 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16367 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16368 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16369 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16370 the daemon's command line.
16372 .cindex queues named
16373 .cindex "named queues"
16374 To set limits for different named queues use
16375 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16377 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16378 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16379 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16380 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16381 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16382 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16383 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16384 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16385 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16386 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16387 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16388 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16389 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16393 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16394 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16395 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16396 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16397 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16398 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16399 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16401 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16402 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16403 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16404 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16405 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16406 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16407 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16408 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16409 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16410 header lines. The default setting is:
16413 received_header_text = Received: \
16414 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16415 {${if def:sender_ident \
16416 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16417 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16418 by $primary_hostname \
16419 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16420 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16421 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16422 ${if def:sender_address \
16423 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16424 id $message_exim_id\
16425 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16428 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16429 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16430 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16431 header lines such as the following:
16433 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16434 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16435 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16436 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16437 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16438 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16439 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16441 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16442 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16443 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16444 message was accepted.
16447 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16448 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16449 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16450 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16451 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16452 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16453 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16454 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16457 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16458 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16459 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16460 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16461 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16462 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16463 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16464 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16465 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16466 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16467 option was not set.
16470 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16471 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16472 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16473 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16474 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16475 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16476 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16477 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16480 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16481 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16482 RCPT commands in a single message.
16485 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16486 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16487 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16488 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16489 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16490 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16491 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16494 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16495 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16496 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16497 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16498 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16499 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16500 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16501 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16502 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16503 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16504 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16505 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16506 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16507 tagged with its process id.
16509 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16510 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16511 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16512 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16515 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16516 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16517 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16518 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16519 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16520 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16521 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16522 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16523 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16524 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16525 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16527 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16528 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16529 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16530 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16533 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16534 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16535 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16536 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16537 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16539 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16541 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16542 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16545 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16546 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16547 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16548 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16549 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16553 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16554 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16555 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16556 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16557 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16558 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16559 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16563 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16564 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16565 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16566 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16567 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16568 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16569 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16570 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16571 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16572 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16575 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16576 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16579 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16581 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16582 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16583 an item in the list.
16584 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16587 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16588 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16589 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16590 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16591 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16594 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16595 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16596 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16597 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16598 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16599 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16600 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16601 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16602 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16603 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16605 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16606 .cindex "environment"
16607 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16608 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16609 default list is empty,
16612 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16613 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16614 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16615 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16616 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16617 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16618 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16622 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16623 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16624 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16625 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16626 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16627 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16628 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16629 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16630 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16631 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16632 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16636 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16637 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16638 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16640 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16641 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16642 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16643 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16644 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16645 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16647 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16648 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16649 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16650 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16653 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16654 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16655 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16656 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16657 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16658 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16659 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16660 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16662 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16663 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16664 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16665 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16666 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16667 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16668 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16669 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16672 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16673 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16674 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16675 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16679 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16680 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16681 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16682 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16683 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16684 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16685 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16686 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16687 . the option name to split.
16689 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16690 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16691 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16692 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16693 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16694 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16695 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16696 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16697 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16701 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16702 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16703 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16704 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16705 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16706 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16707 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16708 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16709 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16710 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16711 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16713 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16714 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16715 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16716 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16717 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16718 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16722 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16723 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16724 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16725 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16726 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16727 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16728 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16729 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16730 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16731 to all messages received in the same connection.
16733 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16734 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16735 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16736 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16739 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16741 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16742 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16743 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16744 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16745 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16746 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16747 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16748 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16749 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16750 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16751 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16752 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16753 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16756 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16757 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16758 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16759 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16760 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16761 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16762 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16763 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16764 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16765 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16766 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16769 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16770 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16771 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16772 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16775 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16776 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16777 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16778 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16779 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16780 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16781 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16782 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16783 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16785 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16786 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16787 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16788 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16790 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16791 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16792 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16793 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16794 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16797 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16798 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16801 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16802 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16803 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16804 &%helo_data%& value.
16806 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16807 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16808 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
16809 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16810 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16811 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16812 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16814 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16815 $version_number $tod_full
16817 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16818 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16819 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16820 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16821 multiline response).
16824 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16825 .cindex "checking disk space"
16826 .cindex "disk space, checking"
16827 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16828 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16829 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16830 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16831 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16832 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16835 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16836 .cindex "connection backlog"
16837 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16838 .cindex "backlog of connections"
16839 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16840 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16841 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16842 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16843 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16844 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16845 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16846 attacks by SYN flooding.
16849 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16850 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16851 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16852 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16853 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16854 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16855 fewer, but they still exist.
16857 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16858 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16859 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16860 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16861 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16862 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16863 does detect many instances.
16865 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16866 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16867 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16868 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16872 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16873 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16874 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16875 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16876 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16877 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16878 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16879 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16882 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16883 $sender_host_address
16885 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16886 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16887 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16888 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16889 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16893 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16894 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16895 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16896 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16897 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16900 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16901 .cindex "load average"
16902 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16903 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16904 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16905 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16906 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16907 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16911 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16912 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16913 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16914 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16915 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16917 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16919 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16920 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16921 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16922 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16923 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16925 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16926 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16927 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16928 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16929 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16930 not count towards the limit.
16934 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16935 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16936 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16937 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16938 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16941 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16942 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16946 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16947 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16948 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16949 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16950 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16951 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16954 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16955 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16956 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16957 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16959 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16960 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16961 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16962 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16966 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16968 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16969 fractional parts are allowed here.
16971 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16973 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16974 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16977 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16978 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16980 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16981 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16983 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16984 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16985 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16986 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16989 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16990 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16993 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16994 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16997 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16998 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16999 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17000 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17001 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17002 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17003 the message is abandoned.
17004 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17006 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17007 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17009 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17010 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17012 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17013 expanded before use and may depend on
17014 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17018 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17019 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17020 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17021 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17022 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17025 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17026 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17027 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17030 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17031 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17032 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17033 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17034 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17035 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17036 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17037 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17038 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17039 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17041 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17042 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17046 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17047 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17048 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17049 the availability thereof is advertised in
17050 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17051 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17054 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17055 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17056 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17057 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17061 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17062 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17063 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17067 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17068 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17069 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17070 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17071 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17072 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17073 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17074 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17075 arrival of the message.
17077 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17078 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17079 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17080 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17081 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17083 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17084 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17085 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17086 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17087 automatically deleted.
17089 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17090 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17091 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17092 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17093 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17094 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17095 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
17096 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17097 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17100 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17101 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17102 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17103 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17104 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17105 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17106 &$primary_hostname$&.
17108 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17109 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17110 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17111 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17112 as failures in the configuration file.
17114 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17115 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17117 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17118 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17119 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17120 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17121 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17122 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17125 The following variables will not have useful values:
17127 $max_received_linelength
17132 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17133 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17134 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17135 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17137 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17138 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17139 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17141 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17142 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17143 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17144 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17146 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17147 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17148 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17149 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17150 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17151 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17153 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17154 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17155 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17156 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17157 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17158 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17159 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17162 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17163 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17164 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17165 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17166 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17167 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17168 domain causes a syntax error.
17169 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17173 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17174 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17175 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17176 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17177 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17178 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17179 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17180 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17181 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17182 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17183 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17184 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17187 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17188 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17189 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17190 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17191 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17192 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17193 details of Exim's logging.
17196 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17197 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17198 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17199 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17200 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17201 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17202 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17206 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17207 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17208 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17209 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17210 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17214 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17215 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17216 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17217 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17218 details of Exim's logging.
17221 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17222 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17223 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17224 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17225 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17226 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17227 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17228 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17229 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17230 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17231 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17232 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17235 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17236 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17237 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17238 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17239 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17240 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17243 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17244 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17245 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17246 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17247 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17249 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17250 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17251 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17252 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17253 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17255 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17256 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17257 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17258 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17259 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17260 contains the pipe command.
17263 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17264 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17265 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17266 is used in a system filter.
17269 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17270 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17271 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17272 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17273 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17274 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17275 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17276 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17277 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17278 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17280 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17281 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17282 transport option overrides.
17285 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17286 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17287 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17288 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17289 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17290 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17291 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17292 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17293 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17294 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17295 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17296 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17300 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17301 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17302 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17303 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17304 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17305 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17306 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17307 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17308 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17309 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17311 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17312 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17313 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17316 .option timezone main string unset
17317 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17318 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17319 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17320 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17321 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17322 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17326 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17327 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17328 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17329 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17330 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17331 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17334 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17335 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17336 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17337 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17338 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17339 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17340 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17341 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17342 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17343 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17344 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17347 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17348 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17349 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17350 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17351 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17353 The server's private key is also
17354 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17355 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17357 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17358 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17359 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17360 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17362 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17363 separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17365 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17366 when a list of more than one
17367 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17369 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17370 when a list of more than one file is used.
17372 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17373 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17374 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17375 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17377 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17378 generated for every connection.
17380 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17381 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17382 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17383 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17384 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17386 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17388 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17389 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17390 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17392 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17395 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17396 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17397 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17398 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17399 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17400 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17402 The value must be at least 1024.
17404 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17405 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17406 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17408 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17411 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17412 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17413 larger prime than requested.
17416 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17417 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17418 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17419 to be used by Exim.
17421 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17422 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17423 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17424 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17426 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17427 then it names a file from which DH
17428 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17429 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17430 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17431 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17432 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17433 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17435 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17438 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17439 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17440 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17441 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17443 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17444 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17446 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17447 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17448 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17450 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17451 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17452 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17453 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17454 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17456 The available standard primes are:
17457 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17458 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17459 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17460 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17462 The available additional primes are:
17463 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17465 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17466 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17467 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17468 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17469 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17471 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17472 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17473 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17475 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17476 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17477 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17478 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17479 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17482 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17483 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17484 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17485 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17486 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17487 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17488 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17491 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17492 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17493 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17494 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17496 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17497 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17498 for valid selections.
17500 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17501 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17502 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17504 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17507 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17508 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17509 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17511 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17512 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17513 Certificate Authority.
17515 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17517 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17518 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17519 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17522 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17525 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17526 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17527 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17528 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17532 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17533 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17534 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17535 files which contains the server's private keys.
17536 If this option is unset, or if
17537 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17538 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17539 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17541 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17544 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17545 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17546 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17547 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17548 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17549 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17553 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17554 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17555 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17556 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17557 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17558 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17559 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17560 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17561 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17562 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17563 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17566 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17567 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17568 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17569 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17572 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17573 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17574 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17575 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17577 or the absolute path to
17578 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17579 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17581 The "system" value for the option will use a
17582 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17583 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17584 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17587 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17588 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17590 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17592 either by file or directory
17593 are added to those given by the system default location.
17595 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17596 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17597 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17598 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17599 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17600 use the explicit directory version.
17602 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17604 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17608 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17609 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17610 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17611 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17612 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17613 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17614 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17615 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17617 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17618 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17619 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17620 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17621 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17622 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17623 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17625 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17626 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17627 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17628 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17629 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17630 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17631 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17634 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17638 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17639 .cindex "trusted groups"
17640 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17641 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17642 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17643 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17644 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17645 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17646 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17649 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17650 .cindex "trusted users"
17651 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17652 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17653 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17654 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17655 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17656 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17657 Exim user are trusted.
17659 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17660 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17661 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17662 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17663 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17664 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17665 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17666 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17667 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17670 .option unknown_username main string unset
17671 See &%unknown_login%&.
17673 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17674 .cindex "trusted users"
17675 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17676 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17677 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17678 .cindex "envelope sender"
17679 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17680 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17681 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17682 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17683 is used) is ignored.
17685 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17686 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17688 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17690 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17691 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17692 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17693 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17694 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17695 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17696 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17697 followed by a hyphen
17698 by a setting like this:
17700 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17702 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17703 restriction, you can use
17705 untrusted_set_sender = *
17707 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17708 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17709 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17710 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17711 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17712 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17713 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17714 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17716 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17717 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17718 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17719 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17723 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17724 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17725 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17726 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17727 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17728 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17729 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17730 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17731 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17732 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17734 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17735 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17737 The pattern can be seen by running
17739 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17741 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17742 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17743 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17744 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17745 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17746 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17749 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17750 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17753 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17754 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17755 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17756 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17757 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17758 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17759 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17760 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17763 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17764 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17765 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17766 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17767 .ecindex IIDconfima
17768 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17773 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17774 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17776 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17777 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17778 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17779 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17780 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17782 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17783 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17784 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17785 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17786 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17790 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17791 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17792 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17793 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17794 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17795 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17796 delivery of the address to be deferred.
17798 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17799 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17800 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17801 routers, and the eventual transport.
17803 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17804 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17805 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17806 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17807 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17809 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17810 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17811 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17812 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17813 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17815 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17816 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17817 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17819 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17821 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17823 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17825 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17826 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17828 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17829 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17830 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17831 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17832 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17833 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17834 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17838 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17840 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17841 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17842 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17843 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17844 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17849 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17850 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17851 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17852 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17853 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17854 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17855 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17856 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17857 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17858 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17861 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17863 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17866 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17868 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17869 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17870 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17871 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17874 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17875 .cindex "case of local parts"
17876 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17877 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17878 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17879 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17880 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17881 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17882 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17885 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17886 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17887 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17888 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17889 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17890 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17891 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17892 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17893 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17895 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17896 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17897 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17898 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17902 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17903 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
17904 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17905 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17907 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17908 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17909 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17910 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17911 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17912 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17913 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17914 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17915 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17916 the router is skipped.
17918 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17919 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17920 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17921 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17922 setting to achieve this. For example:
17924 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17926 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17927 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17928 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17932 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17933 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17934 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17935 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17936 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17937 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17938 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17939 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17941 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17942 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17944 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17945 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17947 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17948 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17949 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17951 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17953 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17955 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17958 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17960 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17961 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17965 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17966 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17967 be specified using &%condition%&.
17969 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17970 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17971 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17972 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17973 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17974 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17975 Router rules processing behavior.
17977 This is best illustrated in an example:
17979 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17980 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17982 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17985 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17988 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17989 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17990 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17991 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17992 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17993 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17994 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17995 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17997 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17998 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17999 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18000 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18003 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18004 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18005 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18006 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18007 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18010 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18011 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18012 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18013 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18014 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18015 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18016 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18017 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18018 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18019 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18020 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18021 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18022 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18023 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18027 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18028 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18029 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18030 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18031 transport option of the same name.
18033 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18034 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18035 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18036 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18037 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18038 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18039 the dnssec request bit set.
18040 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18042 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18043 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18044 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18045 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18046 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18047 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18048 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18049 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18050 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18053 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18054 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18055 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18056 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18057 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18058 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18059 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18060 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18064 .option driver routers string unset
18065 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18069 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18070 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18071 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18072 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18073 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18074 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18075 Not effective on redirect routers.
18079 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18080 .cindex "envelope sender"
18081 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18082 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18083 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18084 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18085 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18086 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18087 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18089 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18090 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18091 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18094 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18095 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18096 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18097 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18099 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18100 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18101 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18102 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18108 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18109 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18110 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18111 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18112 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18114 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18115 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18116 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18117 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18118 setting &%return_path%&.
18120 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18121 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18122 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18126 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18127 .cindex "address" "testing"
18128 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18129 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18130 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18131 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18132 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18133 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18134 on for the system alias file.
18135 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18138 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18139 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18140 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18144 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18145 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18146 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18147 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18151 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18152 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18153 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18157 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18158 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18159 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18163 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18164 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18165 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18166 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18167 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18168 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18169 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18170 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18171 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18173 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18174 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18175 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18176 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18177 transport for further details.
18180 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18181 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18182 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18183 .cindex "transport" "local"
18184 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18185 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18186 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18188 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18189 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18190 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18191 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18192 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18196 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18197 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18198 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18199 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18200 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18201 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18202 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18203 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18204 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18205 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18206 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18207 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18208 &"see"& the added header lines.
18210 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18211 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18212 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18213 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18215 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18216 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18218 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18219 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18221 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18222 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18223 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18224 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18225 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18226 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18227 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18228 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18229 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18230 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18234 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18235 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18236 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18237 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18238 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18239 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18240 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18241 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18242 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18243 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18244 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18245 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18246 &"see"& the original header lines.
18248 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18249 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18250 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18253 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18254 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18256 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18257 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18259 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18260 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18261 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18262 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18264 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18265 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18266 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18270 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18271 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18272 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18273 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18274 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18275 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18276 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18279 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18283 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18285 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18286 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18287 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18288 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18289 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18290 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18292 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18293 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18295 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18296 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18298 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18299 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18301 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18302 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18303 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18304 domain that is being routed.
18306 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18307 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18310 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18311 .cindex "additional groups"
18312 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18313 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18314 .cindex "transport" "local"
18315 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18316 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18317 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18318 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18319 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18323 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18324 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18325 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18326 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18327 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18328 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18329 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18332 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18333 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18334 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18335 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18336 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18337 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18338 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18339 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18340 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18342 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18343 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18344 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18345 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18346 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18347 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18348 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18349 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18350 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18351 the relevant transport.
18353 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18354 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18355 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18358 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18359 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18360 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18361 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18362 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18366 local_part_prefix = real-
18368 transport = local_delivery
18370 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18371 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18373 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18374 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18377 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18378 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18379 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18380 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18383 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18384 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18388 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18389 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18390 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18391 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18392 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18393 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18394 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18395 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18396 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18400 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18401 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18405 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18406 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18407 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18408 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18409 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18411 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18412 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18415 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18417 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18418 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18419 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18420 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18421 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18422 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18423 each virtual domain:
18427 local_parts = postmaster
18428 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18432 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18433 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18434 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18435 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18436 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18437 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18438 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18439 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18440 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18441 redirect addresses.
18445 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18446 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18447 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18448 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18449 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18450 delivery to be deferred.
18452 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18453 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18455 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18456 means of the setting
18460 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18461 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18462 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18464 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18465 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18466 controls what happens next.
18469 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18470 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18471 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18472 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18473 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18474 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18475 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18476 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18478 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18479 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18480 applies to all of them.
18484 .option pass_router routers string unset
18485 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18486 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18487 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18488 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18489 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18490 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18491 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18492 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18493 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18494 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18498 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18499 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18500 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18501 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18502 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18503 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18505 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18506 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18507 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18508 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18512 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18513 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18514 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18515 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18516 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18517 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18518 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18520 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18521 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18522 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18523 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18525 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18526 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18527 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18528 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18529 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18532 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18533 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18536 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18537 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18538 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18539 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18540 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18541 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18542 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18543 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18545 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18546 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18547 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18548 operates as follows:
18550 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18551 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18552 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18553 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18556 require_files = mail:/some/file
18557 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18559 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18560 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18562 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18563 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18564 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18565 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18567 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18568 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18569 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18570 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18571 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18573 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18574 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18575 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18576 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18577 check again in that process.
18579 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18580 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18581 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18582 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18583 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18584 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18585 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18587 require_files = +/some/file
18589 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18590 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18591 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18595 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18596 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18597 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18598 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18599 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18600 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18601 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18602 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18605 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18606 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18607 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18608 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18609 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18612 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18613 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18614 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18618 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18619 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18620 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18622 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18623 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18624 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18625 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18626 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18627 cause the router to defer.
18629 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18630 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18632 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18634 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18635 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18637 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18638 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18639 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18640 of these values that is set:
18643 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18645 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18647 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18649 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18652 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18653 router, but not for the transport.
18657 .option self routers string freeze
18658 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18659 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18660 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18661 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18662 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18663 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18665 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18666 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18667 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18668 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18669 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18671 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18672 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18673 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18674 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18675 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18680 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18682 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18683 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18684 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18685 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18687 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18688 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18689 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18694 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18695 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18696 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18697 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18698 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18699 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18705 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18706 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18707 be passed to the next router.
18710 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18713 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18714 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18715 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18716 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18717 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18718 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18723 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18724 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18725 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18726 address matches something on the list.
18727 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18730 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18731 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18732 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18733 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18734 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18735 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18736 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18740 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18741 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18742 .cindex "packet radio"
18743 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18744 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18745 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18746 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18747 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18748 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18749 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18750 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18752 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18753 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18754 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18755 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18756 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18757 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18758 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18759 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18760 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18761 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18763 translate_ip_address = \
18764 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18767 The file would contain lines like
18769 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18770 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18772 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18777 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18778 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18779 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18780 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18781 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18782 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18783 delivery is deferred.
18785 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18786 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18787 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18791 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18792 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18793 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18794 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18795 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18796 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18797 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18798 overridden by a setting on the transport.
18799 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18800 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18801 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18807 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18808 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18809 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18810 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18811 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18812 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18813 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18814 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18815 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18816 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18818 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18819 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18820 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18821 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18822 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18824 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18830 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18831 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18832 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18833 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18834 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18835 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18836 delivery to be deferred.
18838 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18839 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18840 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18841 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18842 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18843 sometimes true and sometimes false).
18845 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18846 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18847 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18848 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18849 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18850 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18851 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18852 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18854 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18855 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18856 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18857 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18858 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18859 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18860 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18861 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18862 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18863 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18865 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18866 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18867 subsequent routers.
18870 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
18871 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18872 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18873 .cindex "transport" "local"
18874 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18875 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18876 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18877 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18878 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18879 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18880 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18881 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18882 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18883 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18884 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18885 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18889 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
18890 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18891 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18894 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18895 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18897 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18898 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18899 delivering in cutthrough mode or
18900 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18901 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18902 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18903 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18905 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18906 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18907 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18911 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18912 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18914 delivering in cutthrough mode
18915 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18916 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18918 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18921 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18922 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18923 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18924 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18926 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18927 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18928 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18935 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18936 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18938 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18939 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
18940 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18941 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18942 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18943 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18944 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18945 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18946 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18950 domains = mydomain.example
18952 transport = local_delivery
18954 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18955 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18956 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18957 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18965 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18967 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18968 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18969 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18970 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18971 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18972 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18974 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18975 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18976 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18977 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18980 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18981 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18982 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18983 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18984 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18985 generic option, the router declines.
18987 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18988 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18989 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18991 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18992 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18993 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18994 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18995 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18996 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18999 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19000 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19001 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19002 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19003 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19004 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19006 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19007 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19008 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19009 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19010 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19011 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19012 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19013 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19014 case routing fails.
19017 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19018 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19019 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19020 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19021 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19023 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19024 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19026 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19028 The domain does not exist in DNS
19030 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19031 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19032 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19034 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19036 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19038 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19039 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19041 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19042 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19044 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19045 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19047 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19048 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19054 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19055 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19056 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19058 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19059 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19060 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19061 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19062 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19063 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19064 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19067 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19068 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19069 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19070 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19071 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19072 required. For example,
19076 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19077 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19078 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19079 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19080 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19083 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19084 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19085 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19086 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19087 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19088 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19090 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19091 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19092 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19093 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19094 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19095 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19096 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19097 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19099 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19100 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19105 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19106 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19107 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19108 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19109 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19110 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19111 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19112 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19116 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19117 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19118 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19119 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19120 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19121 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19122 only A records are used.
19124 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19125 .cindex IPv4 preference
19126 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19127 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19128 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19129 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19130 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19132 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19133 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19134 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19135 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19136 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19137 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19138 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19141 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19143 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19144 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19145 the address record.
19148 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19149 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19150 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19151 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19156 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19157 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19158 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19159 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19160 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19161 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19162 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19163 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19164 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19169 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19170 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19171 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19172 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19173 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19174 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19175 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19176 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19177 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19178 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19179 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19181 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19182 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19185 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19186 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19187 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19188 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19189 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19193 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19194 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19195 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19196 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19197 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19198 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19199 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19200 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19202 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19203 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19204 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19205 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19206 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19207 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19208 without processing them independently,
19209 provided the following conditions are met:
19212 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19213 &%headers_remove%&.
19215 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19222 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19223 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19224 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19225 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19226 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19227 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19228 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19229 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19230 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19231 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19233 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19234 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19239 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19240 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19241 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19242 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19247 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19248 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19249 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19250 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19253 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19255 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19256 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19257 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19258 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19259 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19260 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19263 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19264 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19265 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19266 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19267 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19269 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19270 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19271 such as that implied by
19275 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19276 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19277 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19278 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19288 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19289 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19291 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19292 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19293 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19294 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19295 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19296 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19297 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19298 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19299 router handles the address
19303 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19304 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19305 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19307 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19309 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19310 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19312 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19313 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19314 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19315 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19317 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19318 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19319 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19320 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19327 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19328 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19329 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19330 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19331 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19332 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19335 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19337 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19339 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19340 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19341 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19342 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19343 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19344 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19345 must not be specified for it.
19347 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19348 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19349 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19350 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19351 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19352 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19353 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19356 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19357 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19358 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19359 delivery to the address is deferred.
19362 .option port iplookup integer 0
19363 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19364 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19368 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19369 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19370 protocols is to be used.
19373 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19374 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19377 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19379 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19380 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19383 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19384 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19385 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19386 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19387 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19388 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19389 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19390 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19393 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19394 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19395 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19396 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19397 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19398 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19399 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19400 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19401 following could be used:
19403 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19404 reroute = $local_part@$1
19407 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19408 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19409 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19410 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19415 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19416 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19418 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19419 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19420 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19421 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19422 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19423 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19424 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19425 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19426 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19427 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19429 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19430 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19431 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19432 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19433 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19434 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19435 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19438 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19439 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19440 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19441 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19442 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19443 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19444 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19447 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19448 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19449 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19450 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19451 below, following the list of private options.
19454 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19456 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19457 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19459 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19460 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19462 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19463 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19464 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19465 of the following values:
19474 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19475 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19476 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19479 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19480 router only if &%more%& is true.
19482 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19483 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19484 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19485 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19487 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19488 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19489 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19492 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19493 .cindex "randomized host list"
19494 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19495 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19496 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19497 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19498 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19499 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19500 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19501 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19503 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19504 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19505 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19506 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19508 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19510 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19511 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19512 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19513 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19514 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19517 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19518 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19519 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19522 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19524 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19525 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19529 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19530 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19531 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19532 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19535 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19536 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19537 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19538 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19539 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19540 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19541 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19542 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19544 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19545 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19546 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19547 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19548 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19549 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19550 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19551 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19556 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19557 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19558 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19559 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19560 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19561 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19563 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19565 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19569 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19570 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19572 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19573 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19574 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19575 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19576 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19577 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19578 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19579 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19580 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19581 in a &%route_list%&).
19583 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19584 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19585 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19586 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19590 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19591 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19592 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19593 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19594 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19595 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19596 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19599 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19600 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19602 This data can be accessed by setting
19604 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19606 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19607 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19608 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19609 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19610 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19615 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19616 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19617 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19618 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19619 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19620 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19621 The format of each item
19622 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19623 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19625 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19626 variables are set during its expansion:
19629 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19630 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19631 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19633 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19636 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19638 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19641 .vindex "&$value$&"
19642 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19643 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19645 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19649 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19650 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19654 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19655 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19656 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19657 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19658 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19659 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19662 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19663 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19664 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19666 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19667 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19670 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19671 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19672 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19673 number follows. For example:
19675 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19679 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19680 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19681 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19682 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19683 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19686 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19687 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19688 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19689 records in the DNS. For example:
19691 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19693 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19696 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19698 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19699 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19700 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19701 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19702 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19703 happens is controlled by the
19704 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19705 &%self%& option of the router.
19707 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19708 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19709 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19710 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19711 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19712 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19713 defined by MX preferences.
19715 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19716 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19717 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19719 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19720 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19721 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19722 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19724 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19725 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19728 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19729 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19730 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19732 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19733 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19737 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19738 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19739 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19740 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19741 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19742 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19743 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19746 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19747 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19749 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19750 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19752 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19753 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19754 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19756 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19757 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19758 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19760 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19762 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19767 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19768 domain2 host4:host5
19770 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19771 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19772 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19773 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19776 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19777 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19778 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19779 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19782 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19783 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19788 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19789 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19792 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19793 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19797 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19798 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19799 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19802 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
19803 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19804 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19805 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19807 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19809 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19810 your first router something like this:
19813 driver = manualroute
19814 domains = !+local_domains
19815 transport = remote_smtp
19816 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19818 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19819 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19820 they are tried in order
19821 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19822 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19825 driver = manualroute
19826 transport = remote_smtp
19827 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19829 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19830 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19831 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19832 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19833 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19834 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19835 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19836 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19839 .cindex "mail hub example"
19840 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19841 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19842 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19843 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19844 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19845 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19846 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19847 lookup is easier to manage.
19849 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19850 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19854 driver = manualroute
19855 transport = remote_smtp
19856 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19858 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19859 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19860 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19861 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19862 domain can be used to find the host:
19865 driver = manualroute
19866 transport = remote_smtp
19867 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19869 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19870 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19871 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19875 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19876 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19877 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19878 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19879 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19880 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19883 driver = manualroute
19884 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19885 route_list = saved.domain.example
19887 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19888 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19889 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19892 driver = manualroute
19894 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19895 *.saved.domain2.example \
19896 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19899 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19901 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19902 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19903 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19904 the address if the lookup fails.
19907 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19908 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19909 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19910 one way it can be done:
19916 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19917 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19918 return_fail_output = true
19923 driver = manualroute
19925 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19927 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19929 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19931 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19932 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19933 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19935 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
19936 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
19945 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19946 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19948 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19949 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19950 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19951 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
19952 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19953 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19954 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19955 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19956 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19957 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19959 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19961 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19962 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19963 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19964 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19965 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19968 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
19969 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19970 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19971 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19972 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19973 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19976 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
19977 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19978 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19979 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19980 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19981 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19982 not set, a value for the gid also.
19984 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19985 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19986 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19987 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19988 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19989 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19993 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
19994 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19995 before running the command.
19998 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19999 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20000 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20004 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20005 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20006 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20007 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20008 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20011 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20014 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20015 &%no_more%& is set.
20017 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20018 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20019 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20020 included in the SMTP response.
20022 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20023 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20024 included in any SMTP response.
20026 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20028 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20029 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20031 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20032 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20033 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20036 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20037 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20040 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20041 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20043 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20044 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20045 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20046 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20048 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20049 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20050 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20051 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20052 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20054 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20055 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20056 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20057 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20058 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20060 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20061 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20062 variable. For example, this return line
20064 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20066 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20067 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20068 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20069 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20074 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20075 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20077 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20078 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20079 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20080 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20081 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20082 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20083 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20084 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20085 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20086 redirected in several different ways:
20089 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20092 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20094 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20096 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20098 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20100 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20102 It can be discarded.
20105 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20106 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20107 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20108 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20110 If success DSNs have been requested
20111 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20112 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20113 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20117 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20118 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20119 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20120 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20121 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20122 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20126 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20128 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20129 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20130 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20131 cause delivery to be deferred.
20133 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20134 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20139 file = $home/.forward
20142 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20143 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20144 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20145 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20150 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20151 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20152 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20153 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20156 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20157 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20158 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20159 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20161 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20162 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20163 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20164 saves some resources.
20172 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20173 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20174 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20175 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20176 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20179 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20180 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20181 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20182 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20183 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20184 document is intended for use by end users.
20186 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20187 described in the next section.
20190 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20191 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20192 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20193 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20194 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20198 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20199 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20200 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20201 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20202 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20203 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20204 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20205 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20206 commas or newlines.
20207 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20210 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20211 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20212 next newline character is ignored.
20214 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20215 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20216 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20217 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20220 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20221 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20222 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20223 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20224 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20225 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20228 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20232 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20233 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20234 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20235 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20236 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20237 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20238 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20239 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20240 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20241 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20242 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20244 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20245 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20246 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20247 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20248 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20250 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20252 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20253 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20254 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20255 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20256 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20259 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20260 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20261 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20262 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20263 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20265 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20266 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20271 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20272 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20275 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20277 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20278 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20279 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20280 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20281 should really contain
20283 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20285 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20286 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20287 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20291 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20292 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20293 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20296 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20297 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20298 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20299 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20300 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20301 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20302 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20304 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20305 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20306 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20307 in double quotes, for example:
20309 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20311 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20312 quote just the command. An item such as
20314 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20316 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20318 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20319 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20320 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20321 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20322 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20323 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20324 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20325 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20326 an &%accept%& router.
20329 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20330 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20331 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20332 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20334 /home/world/minbari
20336 is treated as a file name, but
20338 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20340 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20341 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20342 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20343 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20345 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20346 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20348 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20349 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20350 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20351 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20354 .cindex "included address list"
20355 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20356 If an item is of the form
20358 :include:<path name>
20360 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20361 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20362 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20363 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20364 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20365 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20367 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20369 It must be given as
20371 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20374 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20375 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20376 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20377 .cindex "black hole"
20378 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20379 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20380 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20381 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20385 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20386 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20387 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20389 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20390 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20391 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20392 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20396 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20397 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20398 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20399 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20400 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20401 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20402 redirection items of the form
20407 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20408 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20409 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20410 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20412 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20414 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20416 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20417 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20419 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20420 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20421 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20423 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20424 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20425 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20426 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20427 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20428 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20429 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20430 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20431 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20434 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20435 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20436 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20437 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20439 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20440 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20441 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20442 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20443 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20445 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20446 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20447 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20448 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20449 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20453 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20454 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20455 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20456 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20457 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20458 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20459 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20463 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20464 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20465 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20466 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20467 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20468 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20469 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20470 aliasing scheme of the type
20472 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20476 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20477 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20478 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20481 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20482 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20484 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20485 the pipes are distinct.
20489 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20490 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20491 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20492 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20493 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20494 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20495 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20496 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20497 can be used to avoid this.
20500 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20501 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20502 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20503 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20504 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20505 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20506 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20510 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20512 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20513 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20516 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20517 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20518 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20521 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20522 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20523 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20524 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20527 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20528 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20529 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20530 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20531 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20532 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20533 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20535 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20536 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20539 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20540 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20541 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20542 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20543 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20547 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20548 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20549 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20550 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20551 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20552 let ordinary users do.
20556 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20557 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20558 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20559 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20560 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20561 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20563 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20564 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20565 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20566 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20567 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20568 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20570 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20572 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20573 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20574 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20575 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20576 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20577 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20578 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20579 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20582 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20583 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20584 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20585 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20586 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20587 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20588 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20589 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20593 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20594 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20595 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20596 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20597 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20598 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20601 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20602 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20603 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20604 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20605 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20606 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20608 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20609 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20610 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20612 data = #Exim filter\n\
20613 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20615 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20616 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20617 choice into a newline.
20620 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20621 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20622 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20623 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20624 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20627 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20628 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20629 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20630 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20631 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20632 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20633 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20634 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20636 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20637 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20638 runs a check on the containing directory,
20639 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20640 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20641 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20642 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20643 not, the router declines.
20646 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20647 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20648 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20649 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20650 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20651 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20652 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20655 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20656 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20657 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20658 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20659 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20662 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20663 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20664 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20665 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20669 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20670 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20671 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20672 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20673 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20678 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20679 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20680 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20681 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20682 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20683 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20684 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20685 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20686 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20687 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20688 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20691 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20692 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20693 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20694 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20695 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20698 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20699 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20700 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20701 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20702 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20703 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20705 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20706 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20707 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20708 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20709 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20710 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20711 &_.forward_& files).
20714 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20715 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20716 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20717 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20718 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20721 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20722 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20723 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20724 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20725 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20726 of the embedded Perl support.
20729 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20730 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20731 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20732 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20733 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20736 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20737 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20738 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20739 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20740 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20743 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20744 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20745 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20746 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20747 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20748 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20749 &%one_time%& is set.
20752 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20753 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20754 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20755 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20756 to make use of &%run%& items.
20759 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20760 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20761 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20762 If this option is true, items of the form
20764 :include:<path name>
20766 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20769 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20770 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20771 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20772 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20773 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20774 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20775 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20778 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20779 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20780 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20781 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20782 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20785 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20786 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20787 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20788 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20789 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20794 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20795 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20796 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20797 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20798 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20799 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20800 bounce may well quote the generated address.
20803 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20805 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20806 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20807 file did not exist.
20810 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20812 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20813 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20814 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20816 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20817 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20818 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20819 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20820 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20821 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20822 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20823 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20827 .option include_directory redirect string unset
20828 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20829 redirection list must start with this directory.
20832 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20833 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20834 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20837 .option one_time redirect boolean false
20838 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20839 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20840 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20841 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20842 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20843 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20844 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20845 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20846 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20847 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20848 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20849 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20850 before they subscribed.
20852 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20853 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20854 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20855 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20858 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20859 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20860 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20861 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20863 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20864 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20865 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20867 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20870 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20871 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20872 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20873 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20874 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20878 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
20879 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20880 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20881 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20882 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20883 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20884 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20885 See &%check_owner%& above.
20888 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20889 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20890 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20891 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20894 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20895 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20896 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20897 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20898 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20899 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20900 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20903 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20904 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20905 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20906 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20907 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20908 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20909 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20910 &$qualify_recipient$&.
20912 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20913 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20914 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20917 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20918 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20919 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20920 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20921 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20922 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20923 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20924 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20925 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20926 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20929 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20930 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20931 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20932 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20933 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20934 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20937 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20938 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20939 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20940 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20941 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20942 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20945 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
20946 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20947 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20948 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20949 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20952 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20953 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20954 :subaddress part of an address.
20956 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20957 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20958 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20959 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20962 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20963 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20964 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20965 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20966 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20967 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20968 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20972 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20973 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
20974 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20975 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
20976 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20977 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20978 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20979 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20980 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20981 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20982 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20983 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20984 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20985 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20986 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20987 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20989 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20990 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20991 the following routers.
20993 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20994 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20995 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20996 so it is passed to the following routers.
20998 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20999 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21000 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21001 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21003 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21004 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21005 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21006 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21012 file = $home/.forward
21013 file_transport = address_file
21014 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21015 reply_transport = address_reply
21018 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21019 syntax_errors_text = \
21020 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21021 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21022 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21023 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21024 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21025 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21026 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21027 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21028 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21029 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21031 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21032 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21033 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21038 local_part_prefix = real-
21039 transport = local_delivery
21041 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21042 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21044 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21045 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21049 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21050 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21053 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21054 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21055 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21056 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21064 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21066 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21067 "Environment for local transports"
21068 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21069 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21070 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21071 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21072 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21073 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21074 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21076 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21077 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21078 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21079 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21081 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21082 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21083 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21084 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21085 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21089 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21090 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21091 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21092 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21093 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21094 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21095 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21098 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21099 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21103 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21105 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21106 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21107 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21108 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21113 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21114 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21115 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21116 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21117 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21118 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21119 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21120 group (set by the transport). For example:
21123 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21127 transport = group_delivery
21130 # This transport overrides the group
21132 driver = appendfile
21133 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21136 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21137 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21138 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21141 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21142 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21143 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21144 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21145 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21146 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21148 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21149 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21150 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21151 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21152 original gid is also used.
21154 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21155 following that is set is used:
21158 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21160 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21162 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21163 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21165 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21167 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21168 the uid is the creator's uid;
21170 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21173 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21174 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21175 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21176 The first of the following that is set is used:
21179 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21181 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21183 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21185 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21190 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21191 &%never_users%& list.
21197 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21198 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21199 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21200 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21201 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21202 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21203 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21204 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21205 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21206 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21209 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21211 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21213 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21215 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21218 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21221 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21223 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21227 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21228 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21229 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21233 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21234 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21235 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21236 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21237 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21238 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21239 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21240 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21241 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21242 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21243 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21244 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21245 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21246 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21254 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21255 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21257 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21258 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21259 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21260 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21261 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21264 .option body_only transports boolean false
21265 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21266 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21267 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21268 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21269 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21270 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21271 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21272 automatically suppress them.
21275 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21276 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21277 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21278 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21279 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21280 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21283 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21284 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21285 deliveries by the transport or for any
21286 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21287 what you are doing.
21290 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21291 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21292 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21293 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21295 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21296 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21297 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21298 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21299 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21300 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21302 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21303 transport and the router that called it.
21305 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21306 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21307 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21308 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21309 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21310 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21311 safely be resent to other recipients.
21314 .option driver transports string unset
21315 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21316 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21319 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21320 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21321 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21322 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21323 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21324 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21325 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21326 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21327 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21328 resent to other recipients.
21331 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21333 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21334 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21337 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21338 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21339 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21340 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21341 &%user%& (see below).
21344 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21345 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21346 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21347 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21348 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21349 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21350 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21351 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21352 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21353 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21354 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21356 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21357 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21360 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21361 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21362 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21363 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21364 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21365 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21366 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21367 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21370 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21371 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21372 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21373 This option specifies a list of header names,
21374 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21375 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21376 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21378 Each list item is separately expanded.
21379 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21380 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21381 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21383 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21384 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21386 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21387 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21388 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21392 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21393 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21394 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21395 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21396 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21397 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21398 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21399 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21402 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21405 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21406 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21407 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21408 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21409 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21410 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21411 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21412 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21413 change envelope recipients at this time.
21416 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21417 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21419 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21420 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21421 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21422 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21423 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21424 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21425 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21429 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21430 .cindex "additional groups"
21431 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21432 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21433 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21434 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21435 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21438 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21439 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21440 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21441 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21442 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21443 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21444 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21445 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21447 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21448 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21449 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21450 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21451 Obviously there is scope for
21452 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21453 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21455 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21456 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21457 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21458 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21459 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21462 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21463 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21464 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21465 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21466 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21467 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21468 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21469 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21470 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21471 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21472 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21473 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21474 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21479 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21480 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21481 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21482 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21483 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21484 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21485 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21486 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21489 local_part_prefix = *-
21491 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21494 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21496 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21497 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21498 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21499 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21500 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21503 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21504 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21505 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21506 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21507 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21508 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21509 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21510 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21511 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21513 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21514 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21515 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21516 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21518 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21519 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21520 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21523 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21524 .cindex "envelope sender"
21525 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21526 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21527 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21528 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21529 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21530 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21531 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21532 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21533 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21535 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21536 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21538 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21539 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21540 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21541 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21542 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21543 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21544 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21546 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21547 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21548 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21549 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21550 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21554 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21555 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21556 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21557 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21558 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21559 have easy access to it.
21561 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21562 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21563 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21564 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21565 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21569 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21570 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21573 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21574 .cindex "shadow transport"
21575 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21576 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21577 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21579 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21580 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21581 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21582 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21583 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21584 cause a log line to be written.
21586 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21587 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21588 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21589 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21590 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21593 ST=<shadow transport name>
21595 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21596 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21597 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21598 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21599 headers that some sites insist on.
21602 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21603 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21604 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21605 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21606 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21607 individual users or via a system filter.
21608 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21610 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21611 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21612 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21613 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21614 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21616 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21617 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21618 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21619 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21620 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21621 &(pipe)& transports.
21623 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21624 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21625 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21626 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21627 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21629 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21630 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21631 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21632 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21634 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21635 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21636 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21637 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21638 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21639 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21641 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21642 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21643 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21644 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21645 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21646 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21647 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21648 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21650 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21651 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21652 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21653 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21654 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21655 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21656 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21657 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21658 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21659 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21662 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21663 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21664 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21665 which the message is being sent. For example:
21667 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21668 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21671 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21672 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21673 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21675 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21676 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21677 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21680 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21682 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21683 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21684 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21685 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21686 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21687 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21689 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21690 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21691 arguments. Consider this example:
21693 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21694 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21696 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21697 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21699 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21700 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21704 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21705 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21706 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21707 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21708 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21709 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21710 bounced from a transport filter.
21712 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21713 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21714 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21717 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21718 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21719 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21720 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21721 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21722 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21723 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21724 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21725 becomes a temporary error.
21728 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21729 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21730 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21731 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21732 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21733 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21734 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21737 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21738 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21739 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21741 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21742 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21743 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21744 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21746 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21747 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21748 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21755 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21756 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21758 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21760 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21761 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21762 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21763 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21764 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21765 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21766 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21768 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21769 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21770 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21771 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21772 local transport, for example:
21775 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21776 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21777 recipients saves space.
21779 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21780 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21782 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21783 to a scanner program or
21784 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21788 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21789 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21790 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21792 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21793 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21794 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21795 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21796 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21797 to certain conditions:
21800 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21801 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21802 batching is possible.
21804 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21805 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21806 addresses with the same domain are batched.
21808 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21809 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21810 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21811 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21812 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21815 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21816 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21817 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21821 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21822 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21823 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21824 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21825 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21826 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21827 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21830 escape_string = ".."
21832 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21833 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21834 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21836 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21837 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21838 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21839 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21840 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21841 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21843 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21844 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21845 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21846 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21847 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21848 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21849 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21850 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21851 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21856 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21857 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21859 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21860 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21861 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21862 .cindex "directory creation"
21863 .cindex "creating directories"
21864 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21865 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21866 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21867 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21868 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21869 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21870 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21871 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21872 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21873 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21875 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21876 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21877 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21880 .cindex "quota" "system"
21881 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21882 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21883 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21885 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21886 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21887 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21888 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21890 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21891 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21894 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21895 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21896 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21897 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21902 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21903 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21904 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21905 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21906 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21908 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21909 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21910 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21911 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21912 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21913 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21914 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21915 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21916 operation. There are two cases:
21919 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21920 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21921 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21922 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21923 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21924 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21925 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21927 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21928 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21929 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21933 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21934 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21935 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21936 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21941 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21943 require "fileinto";
21944 fileinto "folder23";
21946 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21947 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21948 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21949 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21950 way of handling this requirement:
21952 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21953 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21954 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21956 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21960 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21961 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21962 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21964 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21965 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21966 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21967 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21968 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21969 path to the transport.
21971 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21972 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21977 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21978 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21982 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21983 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21984 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21985 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21986 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21987 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21988 delivery is deferred.
21991 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21992 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21993 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21994 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21995 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21996 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21997 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21998 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22001 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22002 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22003 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22004 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22008 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22009 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22012 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22013 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22014 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22015 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22016 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22019 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22020 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22021 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22022 process is running.
22025 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22026 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22027 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22028 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22029 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22030 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22031 contains is significant.
22033 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22034 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22035 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22036 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22037 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22039 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22040 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22041 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22042 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22043 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22044 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22046 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22047 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22048 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22049 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22051 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22052 .cindex "directory creation"
22053 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22054 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22055 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22057 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22058 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22059 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22060 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22061 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22065 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22066 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22067 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22068 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22069 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22072 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22073 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22074 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
22075 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
22076 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22077 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22078 &%file_must_exist%&.
22081 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22082 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22083 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22084 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22086 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22087 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22088 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22089 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22090 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22093 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22095 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22096 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22097 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22098 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22100 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22102 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22103 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22107 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22108 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22109 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22112 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22113 See &%check_string%& above.
22116 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22117 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22118 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22119 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22120 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22121 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22124 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22125 .cindex "locking files"
22126 .cindex "lock files"
22127 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22128 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22130 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22131 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22134 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22135 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22138 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22139 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22140 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22141 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22142 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22143 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22147 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22148 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22149 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22150 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22151 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22152 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22153 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22154 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22155 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22158 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22159 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22161 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22162 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22163 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22164 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22165 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22166 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22167 delivery is deferred.
22170 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22171 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22172 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22173 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22176 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22177 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22178 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22179 .cindex "locking files"
22180 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22181 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22182 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22183 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22184 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22185 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22186 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22187 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22189 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22190 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22191 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22192 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22194 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22195 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22198 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22200 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22201 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22202 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22204 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22205 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22207 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22210 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22211 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22212 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22213 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22216 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22217 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22218 for details of locking.
22221 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22222 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22223 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22226 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22227 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22228 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22231 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22232 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22233 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22234 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22235 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22238 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22239 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22240 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22241 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22242 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22243 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22244 external source that maintains the data.
22247 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22248 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22249 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22250 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22251 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22252 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22253 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22254 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22258 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22259 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22260 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22261 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22262 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22263 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22264 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22265 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22266 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22267 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22270 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22271 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22272 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22273 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22274 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22275 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22276 calculation. The default value is:
22278 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22280 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22281 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22283 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22285 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22287 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22288 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22289 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22290 directly into that directory.
22293 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22294 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22295 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22298 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22299 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22300 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22303 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22304 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22305 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22306 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22307 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22308 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22309 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22310 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22312 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22313 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22314 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22315 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22316 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22317 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22318 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22319 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22320 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22321 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22324 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22325 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22326 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22327 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22328 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22329 below for further details.
22332 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22333 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22334 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22337 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22338 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22339 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22342 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22343 .cindex "locking files"
22344 .cindex "file" "locking"
22345 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22346 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22347 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22348 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22349 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22350 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22351 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22353 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22354 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22355 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22362 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22363 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22364 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22365 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22366 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22367 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22368 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22369 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22371 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22372 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22373 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22374 append messages to it.
22377 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22378 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22379 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22380 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22381 in which case it is:
22383 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22384 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22386 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22387 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22389 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22390 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22391 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22392 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22397 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22398 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22400 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22401 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22402 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22403 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22404 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22405 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22406 value, and this option is ignored.
22409 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22410 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22411 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22412 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22413 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22416 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22417 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22418 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22419 on users about incoming mail.
22422 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22423 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22424 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22425 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22426 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22427 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22428 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22429 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22430 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22432 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22433 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22434 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22436 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22437 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22438 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22439 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22440 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22441 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22443 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22444 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22445 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22446 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22447 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22450 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22451 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22453 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22455 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22456 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22457 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22458 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22459 system quota failures.
22461 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22462 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22463 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22464 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22465 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22466 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22467 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22468 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22469 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22470 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22473 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22474 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22475 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22476 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22477 delivery directory.
22480 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22481 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22482 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22483 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22484 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22487 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22488 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22490 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22491 See &%quota%& above.
22494 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22495 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22496 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22497 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22498 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22499 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22500 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22502 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22503 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22504 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22505 the file length to the file name. For example:
22507 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22508 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22510 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22511 number of lines in the message.
22513 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22514 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22515 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22517 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22520 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22521 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22522 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22524 quota_warn_message = "\
22525 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22526 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22527 This message is automatically created \
22528 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22529 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22530 a warning threshold that is\n\
22531 set by the system administrator.\n"
22535 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22536 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22537 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22538 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22539 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22540 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22541 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22542 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22543 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22547 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22549 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22550 percent sign is ignored.
22552 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22553 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22554 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22555 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22556 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22557 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22559 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22561 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22562 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22565 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22566 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22570 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22571 .cindex "envelope sender"
22572 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22573 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22574 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22575 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22576 for details of batch SMTP.
22579 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22580 .cindex "carriage return"
22582 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22583 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22584 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22585 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22587 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22588 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22589 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22590 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22591 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22592 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22595 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22596 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22597 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22598 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22599 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22600 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22603 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22604 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22605 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22606 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22607 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22609 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22610 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22611 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22612 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22614 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22615 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22616 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22617 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22618 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22621 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22622 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22625 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22626 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22627 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22628 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22629 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22630 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22631 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22633 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22634 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22635 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22636 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22639 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22640 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22641 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22644 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22645 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22646 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22647 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22648 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22649 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22650 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22651 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22652 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22654 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22655 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22656 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22657 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22662 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22663 .cindex "appending to a file"
22664 .cindex "file" "appending"
22665 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22668 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22672 .cindex "directory creation"
22673 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22674 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22675 &%directory_mode%& option.
22678 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22679 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22683 .cindex "file" "locking"
22684 .cindex "locking files"
22685 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22686 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22687 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22690 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22691 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22692 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22694 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22696 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22697 Unlink the hitching post name.
22699 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22700 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22701 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22702 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22704 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22705 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22706 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22707 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22708 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22709 it before trying again.
22713 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22714 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22715 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22718 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22719 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22720 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22721 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22722 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22723 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22724 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22725 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22726 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22730 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22731 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22732 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22733 delivery is deferred.
22736 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22737 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22738 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22742 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22743 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22744 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22747 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22748 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22749 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22752 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22753 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22754 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22755 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22756 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22757 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22758 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22759 that prevents link following.
22762 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22763 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22764 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22765 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22766 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22769 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22772 .cindex "file" "locking"
22773 .cindex "locking files"
22774 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22775 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22776 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22777 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22778 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22780 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22782 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22783 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22784 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22786 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22787 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22788 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22790 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22791 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22792 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22793 delivery is deferred.
22795 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22796 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22797 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22798 immediately. It retries up to
22800 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22802 times (rounded up).
22805 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22806 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22809 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22810 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22811 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22812 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22813 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22814 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22815 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22816 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22817 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22818 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22820 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22821 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22822 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22823 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22824 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22825 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22826 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22828 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22829 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22830 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22831 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22834 .cindex "maildir format"
22835 .cindex "mailstore format"
22836 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22837 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22838 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22839 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22840 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22842 .cindex "directory creation"
22843 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22844 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22845 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22846 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22847 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22848 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22853 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22854 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22855 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22856 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22857 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22858 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22859 &_new_& subdirectory.
22861 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22862 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22863 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22864 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22865 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22866 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22867 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22869 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22870 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22871 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22872 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22873 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22874 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22875 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22876 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22878 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22879 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22880 folders. Consider this example:
22882 maildir_format = true
22883 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22884 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22885 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22886 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22888 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22889 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22890 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22891 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22892 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22893 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22895 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22896 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22897 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22898 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22899 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22901 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22902 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22903 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22905 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22906 .cindex "maildir++"
22907 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22908 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22909 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22910 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22911 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22912 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22913 amount of space used.
22915 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22916 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22917 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22918 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22919 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22920 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22925 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22926 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22927 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22928 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22929 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22930 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22933 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
22934 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22935 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22936 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22937 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22938 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22939 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22940 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22941 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22942 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22943 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22944 backwards compatibility).
22946 For one common implementation, you might set:
22948 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22950 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22952 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22953 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22954 &[stat()]& each message file.
22957 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22958 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22959 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22960 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22961 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22962 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22963 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22964 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22965 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22967 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22968 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22969 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22970 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22971 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22972 need to know the quota.
22974 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22975 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22977 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22978 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22979 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22983 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22984 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22985 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22986 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22987 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22988 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22989 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22990 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22992 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22993 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22994 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22995 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22996 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22997 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22999 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23000 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23001 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23002 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23003 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23004 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23006 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23007 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23008 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23009 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23012 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23013 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23014 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23015 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23016 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23018 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23020 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23021 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23022 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23023 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23024 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23034 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23035 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23036 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23037 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23038 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23039 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23040 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23041 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23043 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23044 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23045 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23046 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23047 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23050 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23051 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23052 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23053 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23054 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23056 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23057 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23058 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23059 transport is run as a consequence of a
23061 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23062 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23063 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23064 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23065 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23066 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23068 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23069 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23070 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23071 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23073 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23074 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23075 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23076 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23077 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23078 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23079 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23081 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23082 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23083 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23084 the transport defers.
23085 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23086 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23088 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23089 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23090 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23091 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23093 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23094 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23095 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23096 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23097 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23098 problems. They are just discarded.
23102 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23103 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23105 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23106 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23107 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23110 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23111 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23112 when the message is specified by the transport.
23115 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23116 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23117 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23118 string comes first.
23121 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23122 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23123 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23126 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23127 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23128 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23131 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23132 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23133 specified by the transport.
23136 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23137 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23138 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23139 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23142 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23143 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23144 the message is specified by the transport.
23147 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23148 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23152 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23153 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23154 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23155 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23156 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23160 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23161 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23162 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23163 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23165 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23166 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23167 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23168 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23169 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23170 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23171 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23174 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23175 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23176 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23177 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23178 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23180 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23181 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23182 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23183 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23184 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23185 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23188 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23189 See &%once%& above.
23192 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23193 See &%once%& above.
23194 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23197 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23198 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23199 specified by the transport.
23202 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23203 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23204 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23205 configuration option.
23208 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23209 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23210 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23211 automatic responses. For example:
23213 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23215 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23216 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23217 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23218 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23223 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23224 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23225 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23226 the text comes first.
23229 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23230 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23231 when the message is specified by the transport.
23232 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23233 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23238 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23239 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23241 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23242 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23243 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23244 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23245 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23246 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23248 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23249 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23250 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23251 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23252 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23253 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23257 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23258 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23259 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23262 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23263 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23266 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23267 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23268 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23269 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23270 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23273 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23274 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23275 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23276 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23277 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23278 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23281 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23282 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23283 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23284 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23285 in its response to the LHLO command.
23287 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23288 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23289 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23290 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23293 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23294 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23295 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23296 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23301 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23305 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23306 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23313 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23314 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23315 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23316 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23317 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23318 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23319 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23320 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23324 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23325 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23326 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23327 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23328 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23330 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23331 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23332 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23333 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23334 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23335 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23336 that are routed to the transport.
23338 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23339 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23340 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23341 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23342 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23343 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23344 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23348 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23349 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23350 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23352 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23353 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23354 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23355 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23356 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23357 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23358 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23361 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23362 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23363 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23364 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23365 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23366 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23367 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23372 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23373 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23374 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23375 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23376 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23377 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23378 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23379 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23380 &"local delivery failed"&.
23382 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23383 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23384 will be sent as normal.
23386 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23387 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23388 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23389 apply in this case.
23391 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23392 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23393 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23394 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23396 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23397 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23398 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23399 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23400 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23401 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23402 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23407 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23408 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23409 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23410 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23411 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23414 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23415 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23416 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23417 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23419 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23420 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23421 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23422 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23423 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23425 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23427 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23428 arguments. You have to write
23430 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23432 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23433 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23434 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23435 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23436 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23437 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23440 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23443 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23444 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23445 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23446 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23447 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23448 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23449 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23450 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23451 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23452 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23454 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23455 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23456 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23457 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23458 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23459 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23460 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23461 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23463 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23464 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23465 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23466 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23467 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23468 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23469 control what is done with it.
23471 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23472 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23473 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23474 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23475 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23476 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23477 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23478 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23479 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23480 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23481 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23485 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23486 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23487 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23488 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23489 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23490 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23491 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23492 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23494 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23495 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23496 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23497 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23498 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23499 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23500 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23501 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23502 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23503 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23504 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23505 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23506 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23507 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23508 &`USER `& see below
23510 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23511 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23512 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23513 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23514 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23515 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23516 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23519 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23520 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23521 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23525 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23526 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23527 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23528 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23531 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23532 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23536 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23537 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23538 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23539 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23540 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23541 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23542 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23543 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23544 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23545 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23546 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23549 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23551 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23552 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23553 &%use_shell%& is set.
23556 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23557 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23560 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23561 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23562 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23565 .option check_string pipe string unset
23566 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23567 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23568 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23569 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23570 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23571 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23572 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23576 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23577 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23578 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23579 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23580 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23581 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23582 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23585 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23586 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23587 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23588 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23589 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23590 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23591 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23594 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23595 See &%check_string%& above.
23598 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23599 .cindex "exec failure"
23600 .cindex "failure of exec"
23601 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23602 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23603 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23604 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23605 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23608 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23609 .cindex "signal exit"
23610 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23611 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23612 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23613 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23616 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23617 .cindex "force command"
23618 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23619 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23620 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23621 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23622 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23623 command. For example:
23625 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23629 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23630 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23631 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23634 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23635 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23636 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23637 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23638 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23639 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23641 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23642 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23645 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23646 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23647 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23648 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23649 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23650 written to the main log.
23653 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23654 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23655 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23656 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23657 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23658 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23662 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23663 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23664 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23665 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23666 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23669 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23670 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23671 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23672 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23673 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23674 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23675 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23676 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23679 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23680 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23681 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23684 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23688 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23689 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23690 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23691 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23692 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23697 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23698 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23701 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23702 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23703 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23704 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23708 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23709 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23712 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23713 This option is expanded and
23714 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23715 variable of the subprocess.
23716 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23717 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23718 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23721 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23722 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23723 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23724 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23725 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23726 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23727 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23728 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23729 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23732 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23733 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23734 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23735 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23736 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23737 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23738 accept the message is used.
23741 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23742 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23743 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23744 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23745 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23746 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23749 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23750 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23751 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23752 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23753 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23754 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23755 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23759 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23760 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23761 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23762 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23763 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23764 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23765 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23766 of them may be set.
23770 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23771 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23772 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23773 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23774 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23775 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23776 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23777 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23778 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23779 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23780 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23781 and 73, respectively.
23784 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23785 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23786 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23787 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23788 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23789 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23790 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23792 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23793 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23794 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23795 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23796 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23797 delivery to be deferred.
23799 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23800 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23803 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23804 .cindex "envelope sender"
23805 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23806 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23807 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23808 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23809 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23811 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23812 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23813 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23814 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23815 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23816 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23820 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23821 .cindex "carriage return"
23823 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23824 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23825 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23826 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23828 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23829 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23830 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23831 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23832 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23835 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
23836 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23837 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23838 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23839 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23840 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23841 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23842 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23843 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23848 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23849 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23850 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
23851 .cindex "external local delivery"
23852 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23853 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23854 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23855 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23856 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23857 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23858 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23859 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23860 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23861 configuration for &%procmail%&:
23866 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23870 check_string = "From "
23871 escape_string = ">From "
23880 transport = procmail_pipe
23882 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23883 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23884 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23885 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23886 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23887 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23889 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23893 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23894 use a shell to run pipe commands.
23897 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23898 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23901 local_delivery_cyrus:
23903 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23904 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23916 local_part_suffix = .*
23917 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23919 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23920 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23922 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
23923 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
23926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23927 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23929 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23930 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23931 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23932 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23933 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23934 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23935 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23936 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23939 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23940 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23944 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23945 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23946 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23947 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23948 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23949 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23950 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23952 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23953 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23954 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23955 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23956 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23957 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23962 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23963 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23964 no further messages are sent over that connection.
23968 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23970 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23971 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23972 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23973 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23974 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23975 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23976 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23977 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23980 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23981 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
23982 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23983 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23984 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
23985 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23986 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23987 are the values that were set when the message was received.
23988 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23989 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23990 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23991 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23992 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23993 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23995 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23996 and will be removed in a future release.
23999 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24000 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24001 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24004 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24005 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24006 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24007 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24008 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24009 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24010 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24011 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24013 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24014 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24015 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24016 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24017 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24018 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24019 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24020 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24021 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24024 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24026 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24027 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24028 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24029 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24030 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24033 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24034 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24035 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24036 particular connection.
24038 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24039 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24040 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24041 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24043 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24044 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24045 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24047 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24049 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24050 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24052 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24053 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24057 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24058 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24059 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24060 authenticated as a client.
24063 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24064 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24065 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24066 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24069 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24070 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24071 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24072 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24073 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24074 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24075 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24078 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24079 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24080 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24081 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24082 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24083 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24084 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24088 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24089 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24090 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24091 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24092 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24093 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24094 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24095 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24096 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24097 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24098 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24099 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24100 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24101 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24104 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24105 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24106 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24107 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24110 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24111 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24112 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24113 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24114 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24115 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24116 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24117 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24118 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24119 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24122 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24123 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24124 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24125 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24126 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24129 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24130 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24131 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24132 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24133 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24134 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24136 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24137 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24138 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24139 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24140 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24141 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24142 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24143 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24147 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24148 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24149 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24150 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24151 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24154 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24155 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24156 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24157 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24161 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24162 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24163 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24164 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24165 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24166 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24167 the dnssec request bit set.
24168 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24172 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24173 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24174 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24175 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24176 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24177 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24178 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24179 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24180 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24184 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24185 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24186 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24187 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24188 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24189 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24190 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24192 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24193 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24194 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24195 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24196 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24199 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24200 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24201 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24202 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24203 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24204 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24205 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24206 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24208 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24209 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24210 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24211 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24212 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24213 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24215 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24216 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24217 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24218 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24219 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24221 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24222 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24223 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24224 copy of the message is sent.
24226 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24227 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24228 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24229 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24233 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24234 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24235 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24238 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24239 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24240 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24241 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24242 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24243 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24245 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24246 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24247 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24248 implementations of TLS.
24250 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24251 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24252 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24253 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24254 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24255 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24256 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24261 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24262 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24263 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24264 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24265 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24266 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24267 interface address, you could use this:
24269 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24270 {$primary_hostname}}
24272 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24275 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24276 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24277 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24278 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24279 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24280 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24282 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24283 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24284 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24285 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24287 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24288 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24289 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24290 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24291 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24292 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24293 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24295 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24296 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24297 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24298 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24299 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24300 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24301 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24304 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24305 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24308 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24309 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24310 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24311 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24312 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24313 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24314 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24315 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24316 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24317 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24320 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24321 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24322 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24323 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24326 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24327 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24328 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24329 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24331 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24332 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24333 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24334 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24335 to any host that matches this list.
24338 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24339 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24340 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24341 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24342 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24343 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24344 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24345 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24348 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24349 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24350 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24355 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24356 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24357 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24358 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24359 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24360 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24361 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24362 explanation of when this might be needed.
24364 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24365 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24366 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24367 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24368 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24369 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24370 message on the same session.
24372 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24373 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24374 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24375 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24376 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24377 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24382 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24383 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24384 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24385 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24386 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24389 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24390 .cindex "randomized host list"
24391 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24392 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24393 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24394 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24395 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24396 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24397 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24398 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24400 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24401 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24402 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24403 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24405 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24407 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24408 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24409 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24411 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24412 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24413 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24414 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24415 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24416 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24417 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24418 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24419 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24422 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24423 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24424 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24425 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24426 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24428 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24429 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24430 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24431 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24432 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24433 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24434 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24435 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24437 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24438 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24439 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24440 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24441 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24443 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24444 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24445 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24446 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24447 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24448 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24450 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24451 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24452 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24453 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24454 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24455 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24456 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24458 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24459 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24460 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24461 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24462 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24463 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24464 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24466 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24467 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24468 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24469 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24470 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24471 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24472 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24473 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24474 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24476 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24477 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24478 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24479 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24480 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24481 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24482 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24483 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24484 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24485 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24487 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24488 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24490 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24491 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24492 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24493 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24494 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24496 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24497 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24498 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24499 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24500 for multi-recipient messages.
24501 The option can usually be left as default.
24503 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24504 .cindex "bind IP address"
24505 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24507 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24508 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24509 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24510 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24511 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24512 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24513 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24514 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24517 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24518 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24519 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24520 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24521 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24522 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24524 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24526 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24527 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24528 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24529 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24532 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24533 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24534 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24535 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24536 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24537 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24538 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24539 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24540 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24541 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24545 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24546 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24547 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24548 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24549 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24551 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24552 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24553 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24554 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24555 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24559 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24560 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24561 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24562 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24563 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24564 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24565 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24566 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24568 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24569 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24570 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24572 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24573 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24574 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24575 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24576 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24577 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24578 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24579 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24581 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24582 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24584 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24585 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24586 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24590 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24591 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24596 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24597 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24598 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24599 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24601 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24602 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24603 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24604 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24605 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24607 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24608 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24609 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24611 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
24612 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
24613 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
24617 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24618 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24619 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24620 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24621 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24622 addresses is not affected.
24624 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24625 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24626 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24627 Exim to use only the host name.
24628 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24631 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24632 .cindex "serializing connections"
24633 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24634 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24635 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24636 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24637 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24638 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24639 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24641 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24642 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24643 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24644 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24645 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24646 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24648 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24649 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24650 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24651 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24652 are used for ETRN serialization.
24654 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24657 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24658 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24659 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24660 .cindex "size" "of message"
24661 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24662 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24663 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24664 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24665 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24666 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24667 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24668 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24670 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24671 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24674 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24675 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24676 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24677 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24680 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24681 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24682 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24684 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24685 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24686 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24687 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24688 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24691 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24692 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24693 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24694 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24698 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24699 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24700 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24701 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24702 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24705 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24706 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24707 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24708 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24709 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24710 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24713 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24716 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24717 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24719 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24720 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24721 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24722 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24723 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24724 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24725 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24726 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24729 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24730 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24731 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24733 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24734 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24735 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24736 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24737 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24738 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24739 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24740 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24741 ciphers is a preference order.
24745 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24746 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24747 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24748 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24749 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24750 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24751 certificate and private key for the session.
24753 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24755 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24761 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24762 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24763 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24764 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24765 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24766 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24767 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24768 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24769 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24770 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24774 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24775 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24776 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24777 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24778 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24779 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24780 Note that unless the host is in this list
24781 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24782 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24783 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24784 certificate verification succeeds.
24787 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24788 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24789 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24790 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24791 while verifying the server certificate,
24792 checks will be included on the host name
24793 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24794 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24795 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24797 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24800 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24801 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24802 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24804 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24805 The value of this option must be either the
24807 or the absolute path to
24808 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24809 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24811 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24812 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24813 is taken as empty and an explicit location
24816 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24817 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24819 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24821 either by file or directory
24822 are added to those given by the system default location.
24824 The values of &$host$& and
24825 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24826 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24828 For back-compatibility,
24829 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24830 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24831 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24834 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24835 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24836 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24837 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24838 certificate verification must succeed.
24839 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24840 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24841 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24844 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
24845 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
24846 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
24847 If built with internationalization support,
24848 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
24850 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
24856 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24858 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24859 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24860 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24861 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24862 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24865 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24866 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24867 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24868 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24871 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24872 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24873 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24875 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24876 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24877 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24878 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24879 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24881 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24882 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24883 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24884 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24885 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24886 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24887 see below for an exception).
24889 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24890 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24891 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24892 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24893 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24895 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24896 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24897 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24898 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24899 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24900 reached their retry times.
24902 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24903 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24904 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24905 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24906 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24907 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24908 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24909 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24910 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24911 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24914 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24915 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24916 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24917 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24918 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24919 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24921 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24922 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24923 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24924 possible IP addresses have been tried.
24925 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
24926 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
24932 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24933 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24935 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24936 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24937 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24938 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24939 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24940 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24942 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24943 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24944 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24945 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24946 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24947 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24948 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24950 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24951 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24952 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24953 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24956 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24957 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24958 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24959 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24961 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24962 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24963 facility; you do not have to use it.
24965 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24966 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24967 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24968 address to which it applies.
24970 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24971 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24972 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24973 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24974 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24975 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24978 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24979 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24980 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24981 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24984 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24985 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24986 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24987 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24988 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24991 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24992 illustrated by these examples:
24995 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24996 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24997 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24998 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25000 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25001 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25006 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25007 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25008 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25009 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25010 message's processing.
25012 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25013 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25014 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25015 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25016 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25017 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25018 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25019 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25020 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25022 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25023 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25024 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25025 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25026 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25027 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25028 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25029 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25030 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25031 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25033 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25034 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25035 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25036 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25037 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25038 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25040 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25041 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25042 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25044 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25045 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25046 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25047 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25048 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25049 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25050 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25051 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25052 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25054 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25055 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25061 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25062 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25063 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25064 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
25065 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25066 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25067 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25068 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25069 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25070 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25072 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25074 might produce the output
25076 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25077 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25078 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25079 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25080 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25081 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25082 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25083 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25085 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25086 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25087 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25088 set for a particular transport.
25091 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25092 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25093 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25096 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25098 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25099 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25100 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25101 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25103 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25104 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25105 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25106 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25109 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25110 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25111 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25113 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25114 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25115 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25116 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25117 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25118 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25119 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25121 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25122 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25123 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25124 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25125 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25129 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25130 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25133 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25134 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25135 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25136 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25137 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25138 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25139 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25140 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25141 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25143 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25144 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25145 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25147 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25148 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25149 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25150 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25151 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25152 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25153 of pattern they are set as follows:
25156 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25157 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25158 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25161 *queen@*.fict.example
25163 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25165 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25169 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25170 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25173 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25174 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25175 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25176 rewriting rule of the form
25178 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25180 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25186 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25187 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25188 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25189 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25190 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25194 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25195 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25196 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25197 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25198 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25200 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25202 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25205 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25206 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25207 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25208 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25209 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25210 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25211 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25212 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25213 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25214 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25215 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25216 entry written to the panic log.
25220 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25221 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25224 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25227 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25229 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25232 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25233 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25237 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25239 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25240 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25241 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25242 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25243 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25244 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25246 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25247 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25248 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25249 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25250 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25251 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25252 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25253 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25254 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25255 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25257 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25258 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25259 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25261 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25262 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25265 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25266 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25267 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25268 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25269 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25270 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25271 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25272 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25273 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25275 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25276 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25277 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25278 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25279 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25280 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25281 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25282 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25285 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25286 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25287 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25288 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25291 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25292 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25293 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25295 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25296 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25297 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25298 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25300 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25301 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25302 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25304 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25305 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25306 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25307 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25309 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25313 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25316 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25317 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25318 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25319 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25320 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25321 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25322 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25323 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25325 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25326 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25330 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25331 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25333 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25334 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25335 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25337 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25338 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25339 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25340 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25341 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25342 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25343 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25344 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25346 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25347 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25349 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25351 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25352 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25354 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25355 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25356 messages that originate outside the local host:
25358 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25359 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25361 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25364 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25365 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25366 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25367 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25368 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25369 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25370 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25371 components. For example, the rule
25373 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25375 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25376 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25377 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25378 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25379 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25380 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25381 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25388 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25391 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25392 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25393 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25394 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25395 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25396 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25397 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25398 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25399 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25400 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25401 address, domain and error.
25403 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25404 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25405 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25406 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25407 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25408 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25409 log selector is set, the message
25410 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25411 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25412 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25413 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25415 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25416 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25417 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25418 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25419 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25420 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25421 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25422 domain are maintained independently.
25424 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25425 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25426 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25427 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25428 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25429 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25430 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25431 the local address is reached.
25433 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25434 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25435 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25436 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25437 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25439 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25440 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25441 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25442 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25443 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25444 messages that it should now be retaining.
25448 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25449 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25450 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25451 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25452 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25453 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25454 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25455 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25456 message's sender, respectively.
25459 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25460 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25461 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25462 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25463 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25464 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25467 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25469 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25472 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25474 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25475 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25478 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25479 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25480 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25481 expressions work in address lists.
25483 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25484 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25488 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25489 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25490 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25491 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25492 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25493 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25494 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25495 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25496 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25498 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25499 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25500 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25501 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25504 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25505 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25506 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25507 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25508 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25509 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25510 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25511 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25512 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25513 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25518 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25520 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25521 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25522 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25523 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25524 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25525 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25527 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25531 and the retry rules are
25533 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25534 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25536 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25537 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25538 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25539 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25540 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25541 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25543 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25544 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25545 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25546 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25548 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25549 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25550 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25552 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25554 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25555 textual form of the IP address.
25557 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25558 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25559 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25560 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25563 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25564 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25565 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25567 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25568 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25569 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25571 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25572 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25574 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25575 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25578 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25579 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25580 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25581 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25582 retry rule of this form:
25584 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25586 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25587 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25590 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25591 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25592 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25593 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25596 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25597 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25598 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25599 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25600 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25602 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25603 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25605 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25606 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25609 A connection was refused.
25611 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25612 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25614 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25615 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25617 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25618 A connection attempt timed out.
25620 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25621 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25622 obtained from an MX record.
25624 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25625 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25626 obtained from an MX record.
25629 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25631 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25632 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25633 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25634 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25637 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25640 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25641 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25642 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25643 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25644 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25645 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25649 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25650 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25651 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25652 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25653 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25657 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25658 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25659 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25661 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25662 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25663 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25664 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25665 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25666 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25667 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25669 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25670 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25673 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25674 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25675 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25680 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25681 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25682 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25683 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25684 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25687 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25689 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25691 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25693 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25694 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25697 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25699 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25700 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25701 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25702 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25703 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25705 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25706 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25708 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25710 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25711 list is never matched.
25717 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25718 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25719 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25720 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25722 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25724 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25725 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25726 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25727 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25728 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25730 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25731 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25732 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25733 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25734 The available algorithms are:
25737 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25740 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25741 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25742 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25744 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25745 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25746 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25747 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25748 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25749 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25750 queue processing times.
25753 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25754 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25755 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25756 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25757 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25758 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25759 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25760 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25761 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25762 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25763 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25764 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25766 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25767 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25768 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25769 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25770 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25771 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25774 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25775 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25776 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25777 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25778 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25779 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25780 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25781 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25782 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25783 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25784 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25785 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25787 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25788 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25789 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25790 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25791 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25792 deliveries that have been deferred.
25795 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25796 Here are some example retry rules:
25798 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25799 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25800 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25801 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25802 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
25803 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25805 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25806 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25807 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25808 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25809 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25810 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25811 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25814 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25815 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25816 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25817 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25818 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25820 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25821 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25822 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25823 were not obtained from an MX record.
25825 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25826 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25827 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25828 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
25829 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25833 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25834 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25835 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25836 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25837 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25838 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25839 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25840 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25841 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25842 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25843 failing for the first time.
25845 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25846 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25847 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25848 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25850 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25851 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25852 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25857 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25858 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25859 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25860 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25861 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25862 default retry rule:
25864 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25866 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25867 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25868 failure for the recipient address that counts.
25870 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25871 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25872 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25873 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25874 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25876 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25877 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25878 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25880 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25881 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25882 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25883 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25884 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25885 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
25886 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
25887 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25888 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25889 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25890 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25892 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25893 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25894 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25895 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25896 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25899 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25900 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25901 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25902 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25903 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25904 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25905 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25906 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25907 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25910 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25911 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25912 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25913 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25914 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25915 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25916 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25917 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25920 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25921 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25922 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25923 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25924 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25925 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25926 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25927 time out the address.
25929 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25930 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25931 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25932 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25933 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25934 considered immediately.
25935 .ecindex IIDretconf1
25936 .ecindex IIDregconf2
25943 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25944 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25946 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25947 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25948 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25949 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25950 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25951 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25952 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25953 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25954 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25957 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25958 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25961 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25962 the client's EHLO command.
25964 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25965 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25967 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25968 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25969 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25970 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25971 with the AUTH command.
25973 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25975 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25976 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25977 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25980 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25981 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25982 unauthenticated connection.
25985 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25986 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25987 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25988 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25990 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25991 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25992 &`Connected to server.example.`&
25993 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
25994 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25995 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25996 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25997 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26002 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26003 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26004 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26005 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26006 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26007 included by setting
26010 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26013 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26018 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26019 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26020 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26021 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26022 work via a socket interface.
26023 The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26024 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26025 The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26026 supporting setting a server keytab.
26027 The sixth can be configured to support
26028 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26029 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
26030 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26031 The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26032 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26034 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26035 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26036 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26037 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26038 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26039 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26040 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26042 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26043 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26044 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26045 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26046 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26047 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26051 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26052 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26054 client_secret = secret2
26056 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26057 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26059 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26060 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26061 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26064 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26065 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26066 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26067 authenticating data.
26069 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26070 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26071 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26072 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26073 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26074 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26075 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26076 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26077 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26078 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26081 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26082 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26083 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26084 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26088 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26089 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26090 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26092 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26093 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26094 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26095 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26096 encrypted by a setting such as:
26098 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26102 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26103 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26104 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26105 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26108 .option driver authenticators string unset
26109 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26110 authenticators is to be used.
26113 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26114 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26115 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26116 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26117 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26118 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26121 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26122 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26123 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26124 mechanism is not advertised.
26125 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26126 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26127 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26130 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26131 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26132 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26135 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26136 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26138 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26139 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26140 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26141 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26142 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26143 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26144 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26145 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26146 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26150 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26151 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26152 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26153 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26154 out the values of variables.
26155 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26156 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26159 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26160 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26161 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26162 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26163 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26164 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26165 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26166 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26167 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26168 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26169 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26170 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26173 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26174 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26175 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26176 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26177 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26178 remembered for later use.
26179 How it is used is described in the following section.
26185 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26186 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26187 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26188 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26189 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26193 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26194 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26196 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26198 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26199 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26200 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26201 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26202 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26203 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26204 given for the MAIL command.
26206 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26207 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26210 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26211 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26212 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26213 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26214 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26215 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26216 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26221 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26222 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26223 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26224 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26226 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26227 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26228 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26229 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26230 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26235 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26236 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26237 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26238 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26242 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26244 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26245 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26248 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26249 the mechanisms are advertised.
26251 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26252 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26253 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26254 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26255 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26256 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26257 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26259 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26261 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26263 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26264 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26265 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26268 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26270 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26271 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26272 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26274 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26275 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26276 command. This is the case if
26279 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26281 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26283 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26284 server authenticators.
26288 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26289 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26290 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26292 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26293 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26294 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26295 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26296 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26297 rejected with a 504 error.
26299 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26300 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26301 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26302 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26303 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26304 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26305 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26306 no successful authentication.
26308 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26309 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26310 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26315 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26316 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26317 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26318 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26319 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26320 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26321 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26325 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26327 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26328 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26329 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26330 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26331 command line to run this script on such data might be
26333 encode '\0user\0password'
26335 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26336 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26337 whose code value is zero.
26339 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26340 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26341 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26342 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26344 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26345 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26346 example, a command such as
26348 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26350 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26352 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26353 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26355 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26357 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26358 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26359 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26360 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26364 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26365 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26366 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26367 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26368 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26369 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26372 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26373 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26374 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26375 of the authenticator.
26378 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26379 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26380 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26381 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26382 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26383 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26384 delivery to be deferred.
26386 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26387 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26388 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26391 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26392 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26393 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26394 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26395 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26396 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26397 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26398 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26399 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26402 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26403 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26404 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26405 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26406 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26407 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26408 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26409 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26411 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26413 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26414 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26415 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26416 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26417 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26418 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26419 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26420 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26421 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26422 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26423 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26424 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26425 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26432 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26433 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26435 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26436 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26437 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26438 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26439 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26440 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26441 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26442 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26443 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26444 connections as you do for login accounts.
26446 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26447 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26448 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26450 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26451 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26452 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26454 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26455 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26456 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26459 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26460 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26461 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26462 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26463 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26464 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26465 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26467 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26468 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26469 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26470 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26471 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26472 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26473 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26475 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26476 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26477 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26478 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26480 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26481 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26482 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26484 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26485 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26486 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26487 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26488 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26489 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26490 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26491 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26492 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26493 string as the error text.
26495 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26496 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26497 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26501 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26502 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26503 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26504 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26505 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26506 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26507 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26508 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26510 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26511 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26512 configured as follows:
26516 public_name = PLAIN
26518 server_condition = \
26519 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26520 server_set_id = $auth2
26522 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26523 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26524 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26525 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26527 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26528 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26529 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26530 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26534 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26536 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26538 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26539 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26543 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26544 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26546 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26547 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26548 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26549 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26550 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26552 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26553 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26554 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26556 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26557 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26558 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26559 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26560 This is an incorrect example:
26562 server_condition = \
26563 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26565 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26566 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26567 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26568 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26569 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26570 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26571 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26573 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26574 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26576 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26577 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26578 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26579 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26580 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26583 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26584 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26585 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26586 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26587 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26588 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26589 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26593 public_name = LOGIN
26594 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26595 server_condition = \
26596 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26597 server_set_id = $auth1
26599 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26600 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26601 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26602 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26604 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26605 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26606 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26607 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26608 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26612 public_name = LOGIN
26613 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26614 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26617 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26618 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26619 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26620 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26622 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26623 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26624 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26625 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26626 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26627 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26628 uninterpreted string.
26631 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26632 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26633 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26634 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26635 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26641 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26642 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26643 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26645 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26646 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26647 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26648 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26651 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26652 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26653 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26654 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26655 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26656 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26657 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26658 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26659 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26660 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26661 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26662 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26664 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26665 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26667 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26668 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26669 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26670 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26673 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26674 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26678 public_name = PLAIN
26679 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26681 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26682 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26683 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26687 public_name = LOGIN
26688 client_send = : username : mysecret
26690 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26691 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26693 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26694 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26700 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26702 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26703 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26704 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26705 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26706 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26707 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26708 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26709 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26710 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26711 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26712 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26713 available in plain text at either end.
26716 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26717 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26718 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26719 authenticator as a server:
26721 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26722 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26723 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26724 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26725 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26726 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26727 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26728 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26729 returned to the client.
26731 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26732 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26733 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26734 numeric variables for other things.
26736 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26737 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26738 user name, authentication fails.
26742 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26743 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26744 server_set_id = $auth1
26746 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26747 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26748 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26749 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26753 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26754 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26756 server_set_id = $auth1
26758 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26759 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26761 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26762 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26763 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26768 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26769 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26770 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26771 server_set_id = $auth1
26774 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26775 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26776 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26780 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26781 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26782 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26785 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26786 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26787 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26791 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26792 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26793 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26794 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26795 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26796 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26797 send the message to the current server.
26799 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26804 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26806 client_secret = secret
26808 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
26809 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
26813 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26814 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26816 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26817 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26818 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26819 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26821 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
26822 at A L Digital Ltd.
26824 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26825 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26826 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26827 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26828 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26830 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26831 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26832 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26833 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26835 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26836 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26837 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26838 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26839 depending on the driver you are using.
26841 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26842 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26843 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26844 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26845 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26848 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26849 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26850 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26851 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26852 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26853 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26854 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26855 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26858 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26859 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26860 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26861 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26862 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26863 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26867 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26868 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26869 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26870 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26873 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26874 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26875 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26876 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26880 driver = cyrus_sasl
26881 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26882 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26883 server_set_id = $auth1
26886 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26887 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26890 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26891 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26894 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26895 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26896 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26897 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26900 driver = cyrus_sasl
26901 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26902 server_set_id = $auth1
26905 driver = cyrus_sasl
26906 public_name = PLAIN
26907 server_set_id = $auth2
26909 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26910 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26911 but it is present in many binary distributions.
26912 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26913 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26919 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26920 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26921 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26922 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26923 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26924 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26925 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26926 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26927 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26928 authenticator only. There is only one option:
26930 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
26932 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26933 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26934 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26935 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26939 public_name = PLAIN
26940 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26941 server_set_id = $auth1
26946 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26947 server_set_id = $auth1
26949 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26950 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26951 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26952 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26953 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26954 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26955 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26956 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26961 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26962 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26963 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26964 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26965 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26966 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26967 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26968 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26969 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26970 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26971 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26972 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26973 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26974 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26975 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26976 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26977 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26978 without code changes in Exim.
26981 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26982 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
26984 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26985 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26986 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26987 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26990 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
26991 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
26992 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26994 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26995 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26996 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26998 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26999 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27000 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27002 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27003 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27004 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27007 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27008 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27009 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27010 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27013 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27014 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27015 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27016 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27021 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27022 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27023 server_set_id = $auth1
27027 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27028 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27029 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27030 the password itself.
27032 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27033 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27034 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27035 if available, else the empty string.
27036 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27037 else the empty string.
27039 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27041 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27042 option to be simply "true".
27045 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27046 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27047 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27050 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27051 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27052 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27053 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27056 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27057 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27058 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27059 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27062 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27063 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27064 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27067 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27068 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27069 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27070 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27072 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27073 meanings for these variables:
27076 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27077 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27079 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27080 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27082 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27083 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27086 On a per-mechanism basis:
27089 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27090 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27091 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27093 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27094 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27095 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27097 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27098 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27099 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27100 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27103 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27104 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27105 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27108 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27109 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27111 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27113 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27114 server_realm = imap.example.org
27115 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27116 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27117 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27118 server_condition = yes
27122 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27125 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27126 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27127 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27128 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27129 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27130 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27131 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27134 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27135 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27136 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27137 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27139 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27140 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27141 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27142 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27144 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27145 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27146 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27150 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27151 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27152 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27153 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27155 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27156 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27157 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27158 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27160 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27162 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27163 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27165 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27166 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27167 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27172 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27175 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27176 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27177 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27178 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27179 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27180 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27181 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27182 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27183 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27184 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27185 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27186 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27187 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27191 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27192 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27194 The server sends back a challenge.
27196 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27197 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27200 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27204 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27205 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27206 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27208 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27209 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27210 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27211 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27212 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27213 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27214 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27215 for other things. For example:
27220 server_password = \
27221 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27223 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27224 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27230 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27231 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27232 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27236 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27237 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27240 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27241 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27244 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27245 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27246 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27252 client_username = msn/msn_username
27253 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27254 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27256 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27257 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27263 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27266 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27267 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27268 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27269 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27270 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27271 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27272 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27273 authentication based on client certificates.
27275 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27276 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27277 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27278 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27279 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27280 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27282 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27283 for which it must have been requested via the
27284 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27285 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27287 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27288 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27289 and can authenticate the connection.
27290 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27292 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27295 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27296 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27298 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27299 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27300 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27301 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27302 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27303 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27305 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27306 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27307 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27309 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27316 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27317 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27318 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27321 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27322 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27323 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27325 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27327 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27328 of your configured trust-anchors
27329 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27330 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27332 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27333 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27334 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27336 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27338 . An alternative might use
27340 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27342 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27343 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27344 . This would help for per-device use.
27346 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27347 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27349 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27350 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27353 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27354 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27355 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27360 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27362 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27363 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27364 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27365 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27366 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27369 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27370 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27371 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27372 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27373 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27374 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27375 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27376 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27377 certificates are used.
27379 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27380 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27381 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27382 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27383 between them is encrypted.
27385 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27386 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27387 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27388 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27391 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27392 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27393 in order to get TLS to work.
27397 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27399 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27400 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27401 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27402 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27403 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27404 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27405 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27406 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27407 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27408 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27409 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27411 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27412 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27413 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27415 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27416 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27417 reassigned for other use.
27418 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27420 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27421 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27422 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27424 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27425 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27426 the most common use is expected to be:
27428 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27430 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27431 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27432 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27433 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27434 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27437 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27438 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27445 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27446 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27447 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27448 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27449 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27453 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27457 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27458 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27460 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27463 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27464 cannot be the path of a directory
27465 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27466 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27468 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27470 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27471 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27472 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27473 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27474 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27476 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27477 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27478 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27479 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27480 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27481 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27482 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27485 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27486 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27488 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27489 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27490 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27491 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27493 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27494 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27496 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27497 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27498 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27499 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27503 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27504 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27505 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27506 but not the chosen filename.
27507 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27508 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27510 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27511 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27512 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27513 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27515 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27516 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27517 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27518 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27519 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27520 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27521 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27523 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27524 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27525 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27526 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27527 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27529 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27530 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27531 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27532 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27533 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27534 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27536 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27537 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27538 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27540 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27541 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27542 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27543 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27546 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27549 # chown exim:exim new-params
27550 # chmod 0600 new-params
27551 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27552 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27553 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27554 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27555 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27556 # chmod 0400 new-params
27557 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27559 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27560 stalling is removed.
27562 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27563 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27564 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27565 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27566 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27567 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27568 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27569 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27570 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27571 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27572 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27574 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27575 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27576 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27577 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27579 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27580 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27581 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27582 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27583 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27586 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27587 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27588 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27589 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27590 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27592 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
27594 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27595 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27596 directly to this function call.
27597 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27598 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27599 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27600 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27603 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27605 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27606 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27607 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27610 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27611 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27612 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27616 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27619 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27620 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27623 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27624 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27626 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27627 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27630 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27631 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27632 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27633 not be moved to the end of the list.
27636 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27639 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27640 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27643 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27644 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27645 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27646 choice of clients used:
27648 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27649 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27654 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27656 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27660 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
27661 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
27662 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
27663 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
27665 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
27667 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
27672 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27674 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27675 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27676 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27677 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27678 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27679 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27680 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27681 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27682 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27683 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27685 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27686 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27688 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27689 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27690 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27691 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27692 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27693 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27695 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27696 "Priority strings". This is online as
27697 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27698 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27699 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27700 then the example code
27701 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27702 on that site can be used to test a given string.
27706 # Disable older versions of protocols
27707 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27710 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27711 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27712 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27714 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27715 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27716 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27717 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27721 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27727 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27728 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27729 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27730 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27731 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27732 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27733 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27735 If STARTTLS is to be used you
27736 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27738 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27739 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27740 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27743 554 Security failure
27745 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27746 rejected with a 554 error code.
27748 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27749 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27751 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27752 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27753 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27754 from someone able to intercept the communication.
27756 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27758 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27760 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27761 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27763 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27764 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27765 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27766 that goes with it. These files need to be
27767 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27768 always be given as full path names.
27769 The key must not be password-protected.
27770 They can be the same file if both the
27771 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27772 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27773 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27774 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27775 the server's certificate.
27777 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27778 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27779 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27780 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27781 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27782 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27784 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27785 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27786 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27788 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27789 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27790 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27793 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27794 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27795 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27797 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27799 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27800 with the parameters contained in the file.
27801 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27806 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27807 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27808 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27809 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27815 for a way of generating file data.
27817 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27818 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27819 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27820 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27821 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27823 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27824 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27825 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27826 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27827 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27828 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27829 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27830 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27831 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27833 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27834 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27835 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27836 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27837 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27838 documentation for more details.
27840 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27841 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27844 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27845 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27846 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27847 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27848 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27849 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27850 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27851 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27852 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27853 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
27854 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27855 an explicit file or,
27856 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27857 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27859 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27862 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27863 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27864 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27866 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27868 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27870 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
27871 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
27873 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27874 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27875 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27876 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27877 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27878 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27879 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27880 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27881 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27882 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27884 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27885 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27886 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27887 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27889 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27890 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27891 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27892 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27893 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27894 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27897 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27898 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27899 .cindex "revocation list"
27900 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27901 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27902 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27903 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27904 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27905 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27906 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27908 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27909 file from every certificate authority they know of.
27911 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27912 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27913 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27914 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27915 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27916 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27918 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27919 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27920 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27921 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27923 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27924 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27925 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27926 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27927 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27928 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27929 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27930 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27932 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27933 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27934 support for OCSP stapling is included.
27936 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27937 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27938 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27939 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27940 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27942 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27943 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27944 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27945 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27946 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27949 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27950 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27953 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27954 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27955 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27956 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27957 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27958 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27960 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27961 not any of the chain from CA to it.
27963 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27966 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27967 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27968 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27970 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27971 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27972 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27978 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27979 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
27980 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27981 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27982 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27983 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27984 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27985 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27986 within the &(smtp)& transport.
27988 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27989 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27990 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27991 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27992 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27994 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27995 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27996 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27997 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27998 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28001 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28002 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28003 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28004 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28005 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28006 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28007 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28008 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28009 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28010 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28013 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28014 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28015 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28016 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28018 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28019 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28021 the system default set (depending on library version),
28023 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28024 The client verifies the server's certificate
28025 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28026 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28027 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28028 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28030 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28031 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28032 or need not succeed respectively.
28034 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28035 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28036 is valid for the certificate.
28037 The option defaults to always checking.
28039 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28040 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28041 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28043 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28044 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28045 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28048 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28049 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28050 for OCSP to be relevant.
28053 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28054 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28055 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28056 alternative hosts, if any.
28059 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28060 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28061 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28065 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28066 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28067 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28068 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28069 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28071 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28072 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28073 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28074 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28075 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28076 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28077 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28078 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28079 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28080 outgoing connection.
28084 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28085 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28086 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28087 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28088 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28089 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28090 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28091 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28092 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28093 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28096 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28097 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28100 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28101 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28102 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28103 be of limited use in that environment.
28105 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28106 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28107 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28108 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28109 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28111 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28112 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28113 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28114 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28115 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28117 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28118 received from a client.
28119 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28121 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28122 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28123 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28126 &%tls_certificate%&
28132 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28137 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28138 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28139 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28140 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28141 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28142 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28143 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28145 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28148 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28149 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28150 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28151 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28153 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28154 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28155 built, then you have SNI support).
28159 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28161 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28162 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28163 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28164 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28165 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28166 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28167 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28168 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28169 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28170 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28172 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28173 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28174 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28175 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28176 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28177 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28178 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28180 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28181 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28182 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28183 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28184 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28185 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28186 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28187 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28188 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28190 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28191 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28192 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28193 information is recorded.
28195 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28196 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28197 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28202 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28203 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28204 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28205 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28206 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28207 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28209 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28210 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28211 document is currently at
28213 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28215 and their FAQ is at
28217 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28220 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28221 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28223 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28224 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28225 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28226 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28229 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28230 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28231 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28232 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28233 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28234 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28235 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28236 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28237 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28238 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28239 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28240 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28241 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28243 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28244 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28245 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28246 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28250 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28251 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28252 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28253 with OpenSSL, like this:
28254 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28255 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28257 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28260 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28261 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28262 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28263 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28264 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28265 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28266 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28268 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28269 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28270 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28271 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28272 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28273 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28275 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28276 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28277 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28278 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28279 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28280 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28281 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28282 be a sensible resolution).
28284 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28285 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28286 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28288 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28289 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28290 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28291 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28292 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28293 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28295 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28296 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28297 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28298 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28299 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28300 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28304 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28306 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28307 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28308 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28309 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28310 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28311 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28313 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28314 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28315 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28317 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28318 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28320 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28321 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28322 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28324 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28325 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28326 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28328 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28329 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28331 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28332 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28333 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28334 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28336 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28337 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28338 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28339 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28340 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28341 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28343 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28344 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28345 does require careful arrangement.
28346 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28347 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28348 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28349 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28350 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28353 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28354 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28356 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28357 "MTA-STS", described below.
28359 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28360 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28361 connections to you.
28362 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28363 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28364 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28365 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28366 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28367 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28369 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28370 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28371 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28372 random serial numbers.
28373 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28374 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28375 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28376 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28379 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28381 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28382 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28385 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28386 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28391 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28393 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28396 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28397 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28398 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28399 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28401 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28402 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28405 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28406 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28407 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28410 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28411 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28415 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28416 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28417 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28418 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28419 control the OCSP request.
28421 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28422 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28425 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28426 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28427 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28429 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28431 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28432 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28433 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28434 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28436 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28437 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28438 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28439 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28440 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28441 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28442 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28444 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28448 tls_try_verify_hosts
28449 tls_verify_certificates
28451 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28454 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28455 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28457 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28459 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28461 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28462 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28463 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28464 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28466 .cindex DANE reporting
28467 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28468 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28469 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28470 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28471 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28472 Section 4.3 of that document.
28474 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28476 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28477 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28478 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28479 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28480 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28481 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28482 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28483 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28486 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28487 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28488 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28490 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28491 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28492 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28493 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28494 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28495 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28496 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28500 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28501 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28503 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28504 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28505 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28506 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28507 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28508 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28509 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28510 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28511 one very small ACL:
28515 accept hosts = one.host.only
28517 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28518 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28520 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28521 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28522 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28523 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28524 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28525 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28526 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28527 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28530 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28531 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28532 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28535 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28536 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28537 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28538 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28539 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28540 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28541 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28542 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28543 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28544 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28545 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28546 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28547 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28548 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28549 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28550 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28551 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28552 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28553 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28554 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28557 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28558 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28559 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28560 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28561 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28562 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28563 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28564 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28565 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28566 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28567 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28568 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28569 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28570 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28571 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28572 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28573 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28574 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28575 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28576 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28579 For example, if you set
28581 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28583 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28584 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28585 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28586 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28587 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28588 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28589 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28592 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28593 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28594 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28595 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28596 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28597 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28598 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28599 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28600 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28601 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28602 in any of these ACLs.
28604 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28605 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28606 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28607 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28608 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28609 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28610 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28611 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28613 control = suppress_local_fixups
28615 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28616 run, it is too late.
28618 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28619 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28621 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28622 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28623 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28626 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28627 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28628 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28629 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28630 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28631 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28632 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28633 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28634 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28637 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28638 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28639 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28640 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28641 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28642 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28643 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28644 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28645 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28647 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28648 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28649 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28651 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28652 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28653 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28654 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28658 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28659 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28660 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28661 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28662 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28663 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28664 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28665 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28666 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28667 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28669 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28670 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28671 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28672 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28673 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28674 associated with the DATA command.
28676 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28677 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28678 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28679 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28680 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28681 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28682 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28683 the data specified is received.
28685 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28686 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28687 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28688 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28689 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28692 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28693 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28694 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28695 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28697 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28698 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28699 enabled (which is the default).
28701 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28702 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28703 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28705 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28707 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28710 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28711 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28712 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28714 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28717 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28718 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28719 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28720 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28721 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28722 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28723 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28726 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28727 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28728 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28729 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28730 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28731 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28732 for some or all recipients.
28734 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28735 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28736 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28737 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28738 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28740 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28741 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28742 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28744 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28745 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28747 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28748 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28749 the feature was not requested by the client.
28751 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28752 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28753 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28754 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28755 does not in fact control any access.
28756 For this reason, it may only accept
28757 or warn as its final result.
28759 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28760 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28761 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28762 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28764 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28765 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28767 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28768 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28771 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28772 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28773 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28774 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28775 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28778 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28779 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28780 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28781 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28782 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28783 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28784 situation even worse.
28786 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28787 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28788 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28791 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28792 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28793 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28794 connection. The possible values are:
28796 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28797 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28798 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28799 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28800 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28801 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28802 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28803 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28804 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28805 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28807 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28808 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28809 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28810 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28811 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28815 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28816 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28817 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28818 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28820 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28821 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28823 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28824 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28825 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28826 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28827 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28829 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28830 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28831 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28834 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28835 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28836 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28837 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28838 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28839 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28841 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28842 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28843 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28845 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28846 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28847 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28848 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28850 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28851 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28852 matches the string.
28854 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28855 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28856 want to have something like
28858 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28860 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28861 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28867 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28868 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28869 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28870 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28871 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28872 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28873 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28874 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28875 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28877 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28878 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28879 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28882 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28883 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28884 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28885 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28887 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28888 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28889 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28890 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28891 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28892 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28893 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28895 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28896 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28899 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28900 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28901 recipients; it may create new recipients.
28905 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28906 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28907 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28908 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28909 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28910 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28912 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28913 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28914 used to accept or reject anything.
28916 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28917 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28918 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28919 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28921 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28922 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28923 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28924 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28925 configuration file.
28930 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28931 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28933 .vindex &$local_part$&
28934 .vindex &$sender_address$&
28935 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28936 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28937 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28938 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28939 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28940 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28941 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28942 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28944 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28945 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28946 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28949 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
28950 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28951 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28952 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28953 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28956 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28957 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28958 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28959 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28960 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28961 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28962 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28963 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28969 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28970 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28971 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28972 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
28973 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28974 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28975 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28976 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28977 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28978 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28979 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28980 unencrypted connections.
28983 accept encrypted = *
28984 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28986 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28988 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28989 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28990 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28991 option to do this.)
28995 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28996 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28997 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28998 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28999 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29000 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29001 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29003 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29004 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29005 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29008 deny dnslists = list1.example
29009 dnslists = list2.example
29011 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29012 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29013 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29014 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29015 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29018 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29019 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29022 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29023 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29024 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29025 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29026 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29027 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29028 check a RCPT command:
29030 accept domains = +local_domains
29034 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29035 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29036 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29037 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29040 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29041 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29042 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29045 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29046 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29047 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29048 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29049 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29050 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29052 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29053 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29055 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29056 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29057 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29059 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29060 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29061 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29066 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29067 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29068 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29069 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29070 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29071 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29072 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29076 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29077 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29078 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29081 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29083 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29087 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29088 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29089 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29090 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29091 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29092 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29093 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29094 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29095 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29097 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29098 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29099 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29103 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29104 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29105 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29107 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29108 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29110 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29111 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29114 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29115 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29116 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29117 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29119 require message = Sender did not verify
29122 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29123 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29124 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29125 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29128 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29129 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29130 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29131 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29132 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29133 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29134 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29136 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29137 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29138 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29139 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29140 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29142 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29143 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29144 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29145 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29146 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29147 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29151 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29152 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29153 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29154 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29156 warn !verify = sender
29157 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29161 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29163 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29164 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29165 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29166 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29167 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29171 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29172 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29173 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29174 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29175 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29176 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29177 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29178 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29179 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29180 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29182 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29183 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29184 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29185 on the same SMTP connection.
29187 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29188 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29189 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29192 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29193 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29194 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29196 accept hosts = whatever
29197 set acl_m4 = some value
29198 accept authenticated = *
29199 set acl_c_auth = yes
29201 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29202 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29203 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29205 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29206 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29207 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29208 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29209 error is generated.
29211 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29212 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29215 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29216 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29217 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29218 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29220 deny domains = *.dom.example
29221 !verify = recipient
29223 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29224 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29225 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29226 two statements are equivalent:
29228 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29229 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29231 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29232 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29234 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29235 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29236 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29238 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29239 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29240 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29241 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29243 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29244 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29245 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29246 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29247 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29248 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29249 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29251 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29252 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29253 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29254 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29255 message is handled.
29257 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29258 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29259 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29260 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29262 require message = Can't verify sender
29264 message = Can't verify recipient
29266 message = This message cannot be used
29268 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29269 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29270 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29271 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29272 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29273 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29275 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29276 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29277 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29278 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29281 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29282 message = Invalid sender from client host
29284 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29285 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29289 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29290 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29291 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29294 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29295 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29296 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29297 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29299 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29300 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29301 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29302 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29303 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29304 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29305 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29306 write rather ugly lines like this:
29308 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29310 Instead, all you need is
29312 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29315 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29316 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29317 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29318 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29319 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29320 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29321 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29322 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29324 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29325 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29326 in several different ways. For example:
29328 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29329 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29330 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29334 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29336 accept ...some conditions
29337 control = queue_only
29339 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29340 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29343 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29345 accept ...some conditions...
29346 control = queue_only
29347 ...some more conditions...
29349 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29350 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29351 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29355 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29356 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29359 warn ...some conditions...
29363 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29364 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29368 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29369 &%require%& verb. For example:
29371 require control = no_multiline_responses
29375 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29376 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29378 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29379 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29380 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29381 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29382 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29383 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29385 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29388 deny ...some conditions...
29391 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29392 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29395 ...some conditions...
29397 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29398 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29400 warn ...some conditions...
29406 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29407 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29408 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29409 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29410 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29411 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29412 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29416 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29417 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29418 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29419 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29420 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29421 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29422 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29425 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29426 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29427 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29428 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29430 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29431 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29433 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29436 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29437 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29439 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29440 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29441 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29444 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29445 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29446 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29447 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29448 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29449 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29452 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29453 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29454 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29457 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29458 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29459 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29460 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29461 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29462 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29464 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29465 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29466 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29467 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29468 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29469 logging rejections.
29472 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29473 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29474 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29475 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29476 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29477 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29478 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29479 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29481 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29482 &` log_reject_target =`&
29484 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29485 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29489 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29490 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29491 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29492 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29493 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29494 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29495 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29498 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29499 &` control = freeze`&
29500 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29502 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29503 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29504 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29507 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29508 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29512 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29513 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29514 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29515 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29516 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29517 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29518 &%accept%& for details.)
29520 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29521 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29522 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29523 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29524 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29526 require message = Host not recognized
29529 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29532 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29533 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29534 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29535 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29536 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29537 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29538 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29539 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29540 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29543 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29544 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29545 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29547 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29548 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29550 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29551 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29552 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29555 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29556 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29558 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29559 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29560 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29563 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29564 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29565 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29567 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29568 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29569 However, the original message is available in the variable
29570 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29571 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29572 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29573 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29575 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29576 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29577 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29578 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29579 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29580 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29584 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29585 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29586 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29587 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29589 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29591 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29592 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29593 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29594 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29597 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29598 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29599 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29600 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29603 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29604 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29605 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29606 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29609 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29610 .cindex "UDP communications"
29611 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29612 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29613 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29614 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29615 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29616 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29617 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29620 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29621 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29628 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29629 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29630 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29633 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29634 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29635 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29636 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29637 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29638 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29639 not work without it. For example:
29641 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29642 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29644 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29645 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29646 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29647 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29648 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29651 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29652 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29653 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29654 .cindex "case of local parts"
29655 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29656 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29657 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29658 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29659 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29660 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29663 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29664 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29665 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29666 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29667 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29669 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29670 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29673 warn control = caseful_local_part
29674 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29676 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29678 control = caselower_local_part
29680 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29681 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29684 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29685 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29686 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29687 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29689 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29690 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29691 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29692 is used for all recipients of the message,
29693 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29694 and data is copied from one to the other.
29696 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29697 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29698 If a recipient-verify callout
29700 connection is subsequently
29701 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29702 any subsequent recipients and the data,
29703 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29705 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29706 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29707 Note also that headers cannot be
29708 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29709 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29710 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29711 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29712 this will affect the timestamp.
29714 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29715 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29716 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29717 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29720 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29721 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29722 before the entire message has been received from the source.
29723 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29727 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29728 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29729 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29730 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29731 before the acceptance "<=" line.
29733 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29735 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29736 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29737 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29738 and does not queue the message.
29739 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29741 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29743 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29746 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29747 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29748 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29749 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29750 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29751 by default called &'debuglog'&.
29752 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29753 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29754 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29756 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29757 with the &'kill'& option.
29758 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29762 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29763 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29764 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29765 control = debug/kill
29769 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29770 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29771 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29772 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29773 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29776 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29777 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29778 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29779 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29780 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29781 strings or to numeric value.
29782 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29783 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29784 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29786 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29787 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29788 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29789 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29790 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29793 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29794 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29795 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29796 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29797 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29798 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29799 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29800 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29802 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29803 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29804 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29805 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29806 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29807 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29811 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29812 .cindex "fake defer"
29813 .cindex "defer, fake"
29814 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29815 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29816 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29817 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29818 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29820 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29821 .cindex "fake rejection"
29822 .cindex "rejection, fake"
29823 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29824 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29825 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29826 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29827 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29828 the same SMTP connection.
29830 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29831 message is supplied, the following is used:
29833 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29834 550-kept for evaluation.
29835 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29836 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29838 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29840 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29841 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29842 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29843 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29844 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29845 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29848 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29849 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29850 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29851 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29853 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29854 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29855 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29856 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29857 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29858 disables such output flushing.
29860 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29861 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29862 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29863 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29864 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29865 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29867 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29868 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29869 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29870 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29871 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29872 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29873 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29874 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29875 to be useful in production.
29877 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29878 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29879 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29880 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29881 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29883 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29884 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29885 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29886 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29887 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29888 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29891 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29892 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29893 verification failed"&) is sent.
29895 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29899 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29900 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29902 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29903 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29904 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29905 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29906 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29907 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29908 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29910 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29911 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29912 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29913 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29914 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29915 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29916 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29917 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29918 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29919 same SMTP connection.
29921 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29922 .cindex "message" "submission"
29923 .cindex "submission mode"
29924 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29925 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29926 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29927 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29928 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29929 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29930 late (the message has already been created).
29932 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29933 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29934 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29935 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29936 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29938 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29939 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29940 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29941 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29942 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29945 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29946 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29948 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29950 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29953 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29954 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29955 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29956 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29959 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29960 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29962 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29963 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29965 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29969 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29970 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29973 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29975 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29976 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29978 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29980 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29985 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29986 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29987 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29988 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29989 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29990 to an incoming message, as in this example:
29992 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29993 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29994 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29996 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29997 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29998 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29999 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30000 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30003 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30004 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30006 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30007 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30008 contains one or more newlines that
30009 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30010 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30011 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30013 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30014 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30015 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30016 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30017 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30018 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30019 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30020 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30021 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30022 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30023 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30025 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30026 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30028 until they are added to the
30029 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30030 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30031 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30032 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30033 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30034 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30035 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30037 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30039 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30040 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30042 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30043 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30045 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30046 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30048 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30049 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30050 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30051 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30054 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30055 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30056 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30057 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30058 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30059 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30060 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30063 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30064 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30065 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30066 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30067 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30069 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30070 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30071 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30072 to be a header name first.) For example:
30074 warn add_header = \
30075 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30077 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30078 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30079 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30080 up in reverse order.
30082 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30083 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30084 system filter or in a router or transport.
30088 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30089 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30090 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30091 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30092 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30093 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30095 warn message = Remove internal headers
30096 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30098 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30099 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30100 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30101 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30102 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30103 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30105 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30106 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30108 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30109 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30110 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30111 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30112 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30114 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30115 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30116 warn message = Remove internal headers
30117 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30119 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30120 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30121 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30122 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30123 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30124 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30125 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30126 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30127 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30128 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30129 would have been removed.
30131 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30132 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30133 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30134 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30135 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30136 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30137 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30138 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30139 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30141 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30142 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30144 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30145 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30147 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30148 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30150 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30151 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30152 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30153 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30156 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30157 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30158 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30163 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30164 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30165 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30166 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30167 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30168 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30170 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30171 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30172 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30173 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30174 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30175 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30176 The conditions are as follows:
30180 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30181 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30182 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30183 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30184 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30185 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30186 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30187 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30188 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30189 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30190 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30191 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30193 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30194 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30195 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30196 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30197 The name and values are expanded separately.
30198 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30199 will act as argument separators.
30201 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30202 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30203 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30204 conditions are tested.
30206 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30207 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30208 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30209 for different local users or different local domains.
30211 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30212 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30213 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30214 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30215 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30216 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30217 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30222 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30223 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30224 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30225 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30226 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30227 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30228 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30229 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30230 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30231 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30232 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30233 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30236 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30237 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30238 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30239 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30240 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30241 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30242 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30243 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30245 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30246 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30247 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30248 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30249 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30250 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30251 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30252 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30253 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30254 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30256 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30257 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30258 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30259 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30260 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30261 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30262 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30263 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30264 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30267 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30268 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30271 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30272 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30273 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30274 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30275 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30276 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30277 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30283 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30284 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30285 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30286 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30287 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30288 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30289 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30291 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30293 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30294 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30295 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30297 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30298 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30299 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30300 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30301 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30302 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30304 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30305 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30307 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30308 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30310 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30311 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30312 statement can then check the IP address.
30314 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30315 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30316 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30317 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30319 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30320 message = $host_data
30322 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30324 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30325 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30326 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30327 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30328 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30329 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30330 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30331 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30332 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30333 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30335 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30336 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30337 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30338 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30339 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30340 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30341 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30343 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30344 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30345 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30346 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30347 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30348 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30349 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30352 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30353 .cindex "rate limiting"
30354 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30355 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30357 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30358 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30359 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30360 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30361 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30362 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30364 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30365 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30366 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30367 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30368 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30369 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30370 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30372 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30373 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30374 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30375 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30376 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30377 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30378 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30379 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30380 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30381 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30382 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30383 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30384 influence the sender checking.
30386 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30387 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30389 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30390 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30391 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30392 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30393 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30394 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30398 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30399 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30401 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30402 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30403 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30404 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30405 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30406 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30408 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30409 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30410 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30411 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30412 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30413 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30414 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30415 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30416 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30417 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30419 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30420 .cindex "CSA verification"
30421 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30422 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30423 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30425 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30426 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30427 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30428 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30429 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30430 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30431 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30432 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30433 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30434 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30436 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30437 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30438 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30440 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30441 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30442 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30443 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30444 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30445 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30446 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30447 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30448 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30449 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30450 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30451 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30452 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30453 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30454 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30456 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30457 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30458 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30459 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30462 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30463 !verify = header_sender
30466 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30467 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30468 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30469 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30470 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30471 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30472 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30473 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30474 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30475 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30476 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30477 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30478 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30481 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30482 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30486 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30487 common as they used to be.
30489 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30490 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30491 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30492 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30493 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30494 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30495 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30496 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30497 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30498 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30499 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30500 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30501 independently of this condition.
30503 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30504 option), this condition is always true.
30507 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30508 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30509 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30510 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30511 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30512 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30513 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30514 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30515 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30517 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30518 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30521 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30522 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30523 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30524 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30525 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30526 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30527 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30528 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30529 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30530 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30531 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30532 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30533 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30534 value for the child address.
30536 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30537 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30538 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30539 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30540 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30541 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30542 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30543 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30544 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30545 original IP address.
30547 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30548 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30550 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30551 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30553 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30554 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30555 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30556 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30557 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30558 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30559 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30560 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30561 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30563 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30564 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30565 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30566 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30567 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30568 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30569 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30571 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30572 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30573 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30575 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30576 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30577 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30578 verified as a sender.
30580 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30581 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30582 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30584 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30590 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30591 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30592 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30593 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30594 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30595 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30596 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30597 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30598 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30599 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30601 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30602 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30604 the following records are looked up:
30606 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30607 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30609 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30610 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30611 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30612 use two separate conditions:
30614 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30615 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30617 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30618 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30619 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30622 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30623 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30624 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30625 following special items in the list:
30627 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30628 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30629 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30631 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30632 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30633 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30634 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30636 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30638 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30639 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30641 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30642 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30643 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30645 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30647 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30648 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30649 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30650 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30651 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30652 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30654 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
30655 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
30656 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
30660 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30661 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30662 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30663 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30664 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30666 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30668 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30669 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30670 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30671 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30676 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30677 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30678 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30679 addresses. No reversing of components is used
30680 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30681 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30683 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30684 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30686 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30687 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30688 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30689 up by this example is
30691 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30693 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30694 addresses. For example:
30696 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30697 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30699 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30700 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30705 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30706 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30707 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30708 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30709 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30710 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30711 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30712 either to double the separators like this:
30714 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30716 or to change the separator character, like this:
30718 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30720 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30721 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30722 occurs. Consider this condition:
30724 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30726 The DNS lookups that occur are:
30728 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30729 a.domain.black.list.tld
30731 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30732 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30733 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30734 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30735 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30736 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30737 error for a previous item.
30739 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30740 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30742 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30743 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30745 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30746 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30748 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30749 $sender_address_domain \
30750 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30752 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30753 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30754 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30756 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30757 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30758 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30759 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30761 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30763 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30764 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30766 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30767 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30772 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30773 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30774 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30775 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30776 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30777 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30781 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30783 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30784 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30785 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30787 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30788 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30789 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30792 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30793 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30794 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30795 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30796 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30797 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30798 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30799 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30800 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30801 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30802 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30803 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30804 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30805 cases, for example:
30807 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30809 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30810 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30811 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30812 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30814 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30816 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30817 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30819 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30820 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30821 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30822 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30823 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30826 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30827 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30828 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30830 deny hosts = !+local_networks
30831 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30833 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30838 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30839 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30840 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30841 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30844 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30846 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30847 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30848 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30849 describes how multiple records are handled.
30851 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30852 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30853 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30855 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30857 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30858 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30859 first. For example:
30861 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30862 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30865 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30866 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30867 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30868 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30869 tested. For example:
30871 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30873 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30874 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30875 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30877 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30879 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30884 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30885 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30888 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30890 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30891 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30893 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30895 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30896 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30897 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30898 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30900 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30901 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30903 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30904 previous example is precisely equivalent to
30906 deny dnslists = a.b.c
30907 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30909 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30910 Consider this example:
30912 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30914 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30917 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30919 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30921 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30922 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30923 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30925 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30930 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30931 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30932 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30933 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30934 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30935 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30937 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30939 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30940 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30941 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30942 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30943 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30944 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30947 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30948 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30949 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30951 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30952 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30955 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30957 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30958 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30960 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30962 for the condition to be true.
30965 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30966 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30968 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30969 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30971 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30973 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30974 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30976 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30977 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30979 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30981 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30982 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30984 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30986 for the condition to be false.
30988 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30989 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30994 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30995 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30996 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30997 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30998 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30999 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31000 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31001 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31002 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31005 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31006 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31007 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31008 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31009 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31010 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31011 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31014 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31015 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31017 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31018 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31020 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31021 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31022 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31023 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31024 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31025 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31027 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31028 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31029 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31032 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31033 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31034 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31035 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31037 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31038 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31039 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31043 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31044 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31045 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31046 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31047 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31048 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31050 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31051 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31053 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31054 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31055 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31057 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31059 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31060 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31062 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31063 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31065 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31066 dnslists = some.list.example
31069 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31070 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31071 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31073 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31076 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31077 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31078 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31079 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31080 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31081 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31082 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31083 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31084 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31085 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31087 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31089 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31090 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31092 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31093 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31094 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31097 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31098 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31099 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31100 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31101 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31102 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31103 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31104 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31105 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31107 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31108 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31109 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31110 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31112 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31113 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31114 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31115 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31116 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31117 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31118 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31119 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31120 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31121 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31123 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31124 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31125 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31128 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31129 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
31130 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31131 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31132 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31133 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31135 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31136 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31137 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31138 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31139 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31140 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31141 the &%count=%& option.
31144 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31145 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31146 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31147 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31148 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31150 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31151 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31152 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31153 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31155 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31156 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31157 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31158 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31159 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31160 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31161 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31163 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31164 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31165 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31166 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31167 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31168 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31169 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31171 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31172 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31173 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31174 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31177 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31178 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31179 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31180 multiple different commands.
31182 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31183 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31184 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31185 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31186 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31188 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31191 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31192 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31193 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31194 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31195 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31197 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31198 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31200 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31201 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31202 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31203 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31207 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31208 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31209 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31212 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31213 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31214 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31217 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31218 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31219 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31220 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31221 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31222 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31225 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31226 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31227 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31228 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31229 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31232 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31233 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31234 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31235 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31236 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31237 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31240 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31241 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31242 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31244 up to the given limit.
31245 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31246 consists of refusing the message, and
31247 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31248 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31249 likely not what is wanted.
31252 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31253 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31254 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31255 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31256 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31257 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31258 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31259 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31261 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31265 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31266 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31267 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31268 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31269 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31270 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31271 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31272 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31273 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31275 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31276 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31277 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31278 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31279 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31280 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31282 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31283 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31286 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31287 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31288 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31289 required increases with larger limits.
31291 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31292 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31293 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31294 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31295 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31296 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31297 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31298 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31299 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31303 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31304 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31305 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31306 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31307 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31308 message. For example:
31310 # Log all senders' rates
31311 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31312 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31314 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31315 # at the decimal point.
31316 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31317 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31318 $sender_rate_limit }s
31320 # Keep authenticated users under control
31321 deny authenticated = *
31322 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31324 # System-wide rate limit
31325 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31326 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31328 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31329 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31330 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31331 messages per $sender_rate_period
31332 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31333 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31334 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31336 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31337 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31338 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31339 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31340 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31341 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31342 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31346 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31347 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31348 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31349 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31350 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31351 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31352 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31353 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31354 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31356 verify = sender/callout
31357 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31359 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31360 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31361 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31362 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31363 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31364 The available options are as follows:
31367 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31368 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31369 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31371 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31372 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31373 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31374 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31376 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31377 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31379 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31380 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31381 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31382 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31385 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31386 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31387 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31388 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31389 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31390 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31393 warn !verify = sender
31394 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31396 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31397 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31398 verification failure.
31400 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31401 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31404 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31405 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31407 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31409 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31410 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31411 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31413 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31415 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31418 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31419 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31422 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31423 address verification to:
31426 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31433 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31434 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31435 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31436 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31437 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31438 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31439 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31440 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31441 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31442 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31443 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31444 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31447 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31448 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31449 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31450 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31451 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31452 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31454 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31455 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31456 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31457 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31458 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31460 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31461 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31462 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31463 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31464 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31465 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31466 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31467 supplies a host list.
31468 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31470 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31471 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31472 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31473 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31474 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31475 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31476 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31478 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31479 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31480 following SMTP commands are sent:
31482 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31484 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31487 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31490 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31493 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31494 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31495 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31496 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31497 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31498 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31500 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31501 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31502 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31503 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31504 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31506 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31507 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31508 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31509 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31510 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31515 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31516 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31517 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31518 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31520 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31522 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31523 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31524 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31528 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31529 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31530 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31533 verify = sender/callout=5s
31535 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31536 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31537 the &%connect%& parameter.
31540 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31541 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31542 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31543 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31545 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31547 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31549 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31550 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31551 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31552 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31553 updated in this circumstance.
31555 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31556 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31557 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31558 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31559 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31560 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31563 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31564 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31565 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31566 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31567 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31568 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31569 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31570 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31571 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31572 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31574 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31576 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31579 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31580 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31581 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31584 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31586 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31587 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31588 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31589 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31590 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31593 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31594 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31595 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31596 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31598 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31599 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31600 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31601 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31602 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31603 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31604 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31605 made, until the cache record expires.
31607 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31608 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31609 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31612 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31614 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31615 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31617 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31619 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31620 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31621 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31622 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31626 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31627 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31628 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31629 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31630 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31632 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31634 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31635 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31636 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31637 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31638 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31640 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31641 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31642 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31644 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31646 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31647 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31648 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31649 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31650 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31652 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31653 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31655 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31657 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31658 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31659 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31660 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31661 usefulness of callout caching.
31664 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31666 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31668 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31669 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31670 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31671 when that is used for the connections.
31672 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31673 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31674 if the use_sender option is used,
31675 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31676 and if no other callouts intervene.
31679 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31680 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31681 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31682 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31683 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31684 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31685 these circumstances.
31687 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31688 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31689 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31690 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31691 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31692 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31693 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31695 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31696 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31697 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31698 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31703 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31704 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31705 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31706 .cindex "caching" "callout"
31707 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31708 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31709 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31710 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31711 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31712 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31714 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31715 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31718 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31719 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31720 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31722 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31723 commands up to and including
31727 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31728 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31729 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31730 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31731 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31732 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31733 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31735 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31736 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31737 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31738 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31739 will eventually be noticed.
31741 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31742 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31743 behaviour will be the same.
31747 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31748 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31749 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31750 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31751 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31752 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31755 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31757 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31758 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31759 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31760 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31761 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31762 550 Sender verification failed
31764 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31765 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31766 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31767 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31770 verify = sender/no_details
31773 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31774 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31775 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31776 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31777 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31778 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31779 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31782 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31783 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31784 verification also fails.
31786 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31787 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31790 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31791 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31792 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31795 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31797 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31798 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31799 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31800 verification to succeed.
31802 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31803 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31804 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31805 option. For example:
31807 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31809 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31810 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31812 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31813 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31814 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31815 address and a report is output for each of them.
31819 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31820 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31821 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31822 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31823 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31824 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31825 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31829 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31830 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31831 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31832 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31833 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31834 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31836 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31837 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31838 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31839 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31842 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31844 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31846 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31847 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31849 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31850 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31853 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31854 use for the DNS query. The default is:
31856 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31858 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31859 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31860 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31861 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31864 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31866 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31867 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31868 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31870 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31871 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31872 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31873 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31874 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31875 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31876 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31877 of legitimate HELO domains.
31879 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31880 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31881 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31882 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31885 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31887 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31888 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31889 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31894 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31895 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
31896 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31897 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31898 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31899 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31900 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31901 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31903 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31904 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31905 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31906 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31907 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31908 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31909 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31910 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31912 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31913 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31916 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31917 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31920 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31921 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31924 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31925 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31927 recipients = +batv_senders
31929 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31930 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31932 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31933 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31934 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31936 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31937 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31938 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31939 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31940 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31942 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31943 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31944 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31945 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31946 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31947 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31948 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31950 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31951 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31952 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31953 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31957 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31959 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31960 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31961 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31964 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31967 external_smtp_batv:
31969 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31970 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31971 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31972 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31975 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31979 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31980 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31981 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31982 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31983 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31984 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31985 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31986 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31987 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31988 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31990 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31991 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31992 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31993 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31994 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31995 same host is fulfilling both functions,
31997 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
31999 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32000 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32001 system to arbitrary domains.
32004 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32005 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32006 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32007 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32010 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32011 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32012 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32014 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32015 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32017 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32018 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32022 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32024 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32025 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32026 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32028 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32032 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32033 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32035 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32036 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32037 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32038 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32039 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32040 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32041 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32045 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32046 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32047 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32048 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32049 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32054 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32055 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32057 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32058 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32059 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32060 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32061 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32062 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32065 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32066 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32067 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32068 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32069 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32071 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32072 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32073 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32076 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32077 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32079 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32080 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32081 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32083 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32084 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32086 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32089 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32092 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32093 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32094 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32095 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32096 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32097 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32099 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32100 temporarily created in a file called:
32102 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32104 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32105 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32106 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32107 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32108 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32110 control = no_mbox_unspool
32112 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32113 same directory by default.
32117 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32118 .cindex "virus scanning"
32119 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32120 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32121 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32122 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32123 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32124 in memory and thus are much faster.
32126 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32127 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32129 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32130 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32131 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32132 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32134 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32136 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32138 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32140 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32142 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32143 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32144 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32148 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32149 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32150 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32151 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32152 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32153 This scanner type takes one option,
32154 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32155 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32156 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32157 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32158 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32159 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32160 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32162 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32163 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32164 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32165 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32170 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32171 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32172 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32174 If you omit the argument, the default path
32175 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32177 If you use a remote host,
32178 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32179 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32180 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32182 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32188 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32189 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32190 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32192 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32193 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32194 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32195 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32196 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32199 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32204 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32205 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32206 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32207 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32208 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32210 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32211 a UNIX socket specification,
32212 a TCP socket specification,
32213 or a (global) option.
32215 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32216 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32217 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32218 and the second a port number,
32219 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32220 These per-server options are supported:
32222 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32225 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32226 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32228 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32232 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32233 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32234 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32235 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32236 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32238 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32240 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32241 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32242 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32243 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32245 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32246 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32247 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32248 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32249 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32250 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32251 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32252 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32253 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32255 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32256 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32257 (Connection refused)
32260 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32261 contributing the code for this scanner.
32264 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32265 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32266 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32267 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32270 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32271 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32274 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32275 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32276 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32277 the &"trigger"& expression.
32280 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32281 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32282 &"name"& expression.
32285 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32287 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32289 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32290 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32291 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32292 configuration setting:
32294 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32295 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32296 found in file:'(.+)'
32299 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32300 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32302 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32303 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32304 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32305 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32308 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32309 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32311 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32312 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32315 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32316 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32317 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32321 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32323 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32325 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32326 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32327 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32328 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32331 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32333 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32336 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32337 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32338 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32340 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32342 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32343 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32345 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32346 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32347 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32348 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32349 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32352 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32354 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32357 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32358 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32359 though some documentation was available in English.
32360 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32361 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32362 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32364 The only option for this scanner type is
32365 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32366 provided that mksd has
32367 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32369 av_scanner = mksd:2
32371 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32374 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32375 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32376 running on the local machine.
32377 There are four options:
32378 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32379 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32380 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32381 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32382 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32385 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32387 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32388 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32389 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32390 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32391 specify an empty element to get this.
32394 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32395 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32396 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32397 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32398 client communication. For example:
32400 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32402 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32406 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32407 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32410 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32411 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32412 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32413 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32414 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32415 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32418 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32419 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32420 The first element can then be one of
32423 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32424 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32427 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32428 the condition fails immediately.
32430 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32431 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32432 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32433 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32434 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32437 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32438 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32439 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32441 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32442 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32445 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32447 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32449 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32450 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32451 is set to record the actual address used.
32453 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32454 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32455 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32456 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32459 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32460 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32462 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32464 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32467 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32469 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32470 malware = */defer_ok
32472 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32473 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32475 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32477 in the main Exim configuration.
32479 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32480 set acl_m0 = sophie
32483 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32484 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32489 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32490 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32491 .cindex "spam scanning"
32492 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32494 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32495 score and a report for the message.
32496 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32498 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32499 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32500 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32502 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32504 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32506 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32507 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32510 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32511 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32512 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32513 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32514 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32515 configuration as follows (example):
32517 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32519 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32520 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32521 iptables firewall, consider setting
32522 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32523 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32524 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32525 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32529 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32531 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32533 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32536 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32537 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32538 file name instead of an address/port pair:
32540 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32542 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32543 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32544 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32545 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32547 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32548 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32551 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32552 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32553 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32556 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32557 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32558 and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32560 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32561 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32562 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32563 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32565 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32567 The supported options are:
32569 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32570 weight=<value> Selection bias
32571 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32572 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32573 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32574 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32577 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32578 higher values being tried first.
32579 The default priority is 1.
32581 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32582 Within a priority set
32583 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32584 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32586 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32587 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32588 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32589 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32591 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32592 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32594 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32595 The default value is two minutes.
32597 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32598 a failed connect is made.
32599 The default is to not retry.
32601 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32602 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32603 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32606 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32607 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32608 is set to record the actual address used.
32610 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32611 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32613 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32616 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32617 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32618 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32619 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32620 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32623 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32624 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32625 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32626 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32627 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32629 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32630 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32632 or the use of PRDR,
32633 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32634 are needed to use this feature.
32636 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32637 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32638 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32641 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32642 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32643 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32646 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32647 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32651 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32652 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32653 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32654 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32656 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32657 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32659 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32660 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32661 available for use at delivery time.
32664 .vitem &$spam_score$&
32665 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32666 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32668 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32669 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32670 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32671 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32672 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32674 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
32675 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32676 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32677 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32678 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32679 spam bar is 50 characters.
32681 .vitem &$spam_report$&
32682 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32683 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32684 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32685 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32686 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32687 unencoded in headers.
32689 .vitem &$spam_action$&
32690 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32691 spam score versus threshold.
32692 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32696 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32697 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32698 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32700 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32701 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32702 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32703 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32704 spam condition, like this:
32706 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32707 spam = joe/defer_ok
32709 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32711 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32714 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32715 warn spam = nobody:true
32716 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32717 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32719 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32720 # is over threshold
32722 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32724 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32725 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32727 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32732 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32733 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32734 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
32735 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32736 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32737 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32738 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32739 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32740 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32741 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32744 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32745 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32746 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32747 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32748 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32749 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32750 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32752 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32753 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32754 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32755 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32756 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32758 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32759 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32760 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32761 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32762 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32765 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32767 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32771 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32773 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32774 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32775 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32776 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32778 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32779 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32780 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32781 the full path and file name.
32783 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32784 filename, and the default path is then used.
32786 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32787 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32788 a file with its original, proposed filename using
32790 decode = $mime_filename
32792 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32793 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32794 automatically unlinked.
32796 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32797 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32798 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32799 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32800 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32802 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32803 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32804 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32806 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32807 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32808 available in the MIME ACL:
32811 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32812 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32813 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32814 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32815 contains the empty string.
32817 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
32818 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32819 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32825 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32826 case-insensitively.
32828 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32829 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32830 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32831 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32832 only used for display purposes.
32834 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32835 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32836 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32838 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32839 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32840 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32842 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32843 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32844 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32845 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32846 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32848 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32849 This variable contains the normalized content of the
32850 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32851 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32853 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32854 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32855 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32856 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32860 application/octet-stream
32864 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32867 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32868 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32869 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32870 containing the decoded data.
32875 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
32876 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32877 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32878 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32881 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32883 found, this variable contains the empty string.
32885 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32886 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32887 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32888 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32890 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32891 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32895 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32898 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32899 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32902 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32903 and the rest are attachments.
32906 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32909 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32910 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32911 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32913 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32914 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32915 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32916 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32918 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32919 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32920 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32921 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32922 want to carry out specific actions on them.
32924 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32925 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32926 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32927 decoding is fully recursive.
32929 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32930 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32931 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32932 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32933 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32934 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32935 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32940 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32941 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32942 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32943 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32944 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32946 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32947 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32948 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32949 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32950 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32952 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32953 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32954 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32955 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32956 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
32957 32K characters are checked.
32959 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32960 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32961 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32962 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32963 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32965 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32966 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32968 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32969 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32970 matching regular expression.
32971 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32972 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32974 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32982 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32985 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32986 "Local scan function"
32987 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32988 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32989 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32990 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32991 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32993 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32994 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32995 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32996 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32997 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32999 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33000 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33001 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33002 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33004 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33005 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33006 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33007 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33009 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33010 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33011 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33012 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33013 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33014 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33015 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33016 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33017 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33021 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33022 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33023 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33024 function is before building Exim, by setting
33026 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33028 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33029 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33030 directory, so you might set
33032 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33033 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33035 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33036 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33037 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33038 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33039 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33040 _src/local_scan.c_.
33042 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
33043 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33045 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33047 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33052 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33053 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33054 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33056 #include "local_scan.h"
33058 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33059 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33060 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33061 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33062 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33063 strings and pointers to character strings:
33065 #define CS (char *)
33066 #define CCS (const char *)
33067 #define CSS (char **)
33068 #define US (unsigned char *)
33069 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33070 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33072 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33074 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33076 The arguments are as follows:
33079 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33080 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33081 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33083 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33084 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33085 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33086 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33087 case this changes in some future version.
33089 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33090 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33093 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33096 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33097 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33098 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33099 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33100 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33101 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33103 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33104 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33105 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33107 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33108 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33109 queued without immediate delivery.
33111 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33112 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33113 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33114 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33115 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33118 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33119 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33120 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33123 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33124 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33125 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33126 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33127 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33128 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33129 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33131 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33132 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33133 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33136 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33137 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33138 &%-oe%& command line options.
33142 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33143 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33144 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33145 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33146 want to do this, you must have the line
33148 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33150 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33151 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33152 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33155 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33156 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33157 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33158 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33159 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33160 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33162 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33163 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33165 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33166 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33167 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33170 int local_scan_options_count =
33171 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33173 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33174 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33178 my_string = some string of text...
33180 The available types of option data are as follows:
33183 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33184 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33185 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33186 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33187 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33188 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33191 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33192 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33193 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33194 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33197 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33198 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33201 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33202 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33203 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33204 printed with the suffix K or M.
33206 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33207 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33208 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33209 always output in octal.
33211 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33212 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33213 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33215 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33216 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33217 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33220 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33221 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33225 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33226 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33227 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33228 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33229 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33230 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33231 C variables are as follows:
33234 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33235 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33236 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33238 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33239 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33240 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33242 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33243 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33244 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33245 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33248 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33249 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33250 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33253 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33254 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33258 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33259 selected, you should use code like this:
33261 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33262 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33264 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33265 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33266 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33268 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33269 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33272 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33273 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33275 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33276 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33278 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33279 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33280 &%-bh%& command line option.
33282 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33283 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33284 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33286 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33287 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33288 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33289 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33291 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33292 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33293 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33295 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33296 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33298 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33299 The number of accepted recipients.
33301 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33302 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33303 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33304 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33305 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33306 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33307 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33308 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33309 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33310 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33311 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33312 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33314 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33315 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33317 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33318 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33319 locally-submitted messages.
33321 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33322 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33323 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33325 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33326 The name of the sending host, if known.
33328 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33329 The port on the sending host.
33331 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33332 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33334 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33335 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33337 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33338 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33339 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33343 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33344 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33345 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33346 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33351 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33352 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33354 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33355 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33356 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33357 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33358 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33359 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33360 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33362 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33363 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33366 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33367 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33368 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33373 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33374 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33377 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33378 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33380 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33381 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33382 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33383 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33385 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33386 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33387 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33388 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33389 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33390 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33391 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33392 is NULL for all recipients.
33397 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33398 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33399 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33400 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33404 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33405 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33407 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33408 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33409 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33410 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33412 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33413 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33414 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33415 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33416 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33418 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33420 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33421 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33422 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33423 return value is as follows:
33428 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33434 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33440 The process timed out.
33444 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33447 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33448 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33449 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33450 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33451 forks a subprocess that is running
33453 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33455 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33456 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33457 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33458 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33460 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33461 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33462 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33463 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33466 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33467 *sender_authentication)*&
33468 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33471 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33473 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33476 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33477 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33478 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33479 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33480 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33482 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33483 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33486 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33487 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33488 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33489 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33490 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33491 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33492 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33493 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33495 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33496 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33497 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33498 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33499 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33500 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33502 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33503 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33504 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33505 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33507 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33508 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33509 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33510 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33511 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33512 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33513 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33514 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33515 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33516 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33518 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33519 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33521 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33522 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33525 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33526 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33527 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33528 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33529 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33532 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33533 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33534 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33535 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33536 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33537 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33539 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33541 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33542 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33543 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33544 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33545 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33548 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33549 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33550 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33551 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33552 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33553 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33554 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33555 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33557 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33558 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33559 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33561 &`OK `& match succeeded
33562 &`FAIL `& match failed
33563 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33565 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33566 inability to contact a database.
33568 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33570 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33571 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33572 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33574 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33576 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33577 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33578 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33580 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33582 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33585 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33587 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33588 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33589 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33590 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33591 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33592 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33595 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33597 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33598 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33599 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33600 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33601 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33602 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33605 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33606 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33607 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33608 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33610 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33611 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33612 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33613 value afterwards. For example:
33615 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33616 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33617 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33620 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33621 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33622 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33623 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33630 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33631 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33632 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33633 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33634 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33635 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33636 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33637 binary string is returned with an error message.
33639 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33640 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33641 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33643 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33644 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33645 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33646 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33647 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33649 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33650 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33651 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33653 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33654 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33655 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33656 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33660 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33661 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33664 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33665 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33666 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33667 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33668 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33669 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33670 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33671 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33674 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33675 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33677 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33678 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33679 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33680 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33681 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33682 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33683 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33685 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33686 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33688 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33689 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33690 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33691 multiple output lines.
33693 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33694 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33695 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33696 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33697 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33698 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33699 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33702 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33703 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33704 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33705 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33707 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33708 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33709 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33711 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33714 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33717 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33718 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33719 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33720 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33721 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33722 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33728 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33729 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33730 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33731 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33732 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33733 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33734 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33737 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33738 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33739 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33740 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33742 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33743 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33745 store_pool = POOL_PERM
33747 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33748 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33749 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33750 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33752 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33753 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33754 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33755 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33763 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33765 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33766 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33767 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33768 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33769 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33770 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33771 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33772 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33774 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33775 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33776 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33777 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33778 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33780 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33781 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33782 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33783 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33784 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33785 prevent it happening on retries.
33787 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33788 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
33789 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33790 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33791 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33792 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33793 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33794 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33797 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33798 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33799 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33800 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33801 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33802 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33803 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33805 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33806 system_filter_user = exim
33808 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33809 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33810 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33811 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33812 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33813 by the &%reply%& command.
33816 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33817 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33818 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33819 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33821 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33822 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33826 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33827 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33828 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33829 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33830 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33831 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33834 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33835 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33836 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33837 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33838 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33839 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33840 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33842 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33843 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33844 succeed, it will not be tried again.
33845 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33846 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33848 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33849 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33850 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33851 to which users' filter files can refer.
33855 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33856 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
33857 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33858 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33859 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33863 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33864 .cindex "freezing messages"
33865 .cindex "message" "freezing"
33866 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
33867 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33868 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33869 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33870 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33871 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33872 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33873 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33874 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33876 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33878 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33880 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33881 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33882 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33883 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33884 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33887 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33888 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33889 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33890 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33892 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33893 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33894 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33895 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33896 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33897 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33898 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33899 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33900 message. For example:
33902 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33903 because it contains attachments that we are \
33904 not prepared to receive."
33907 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33908 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33909 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33910 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33911 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33912 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33915 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33916 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33918 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33919 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33920 generated by the filter.
33922 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33924 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33925 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33931 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33932 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33937 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33938 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33939 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33940 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33941 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33943 headers add <string>
33944 headers remove <string>
33946 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33947 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33948 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33949 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33950 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33952 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33953 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33954 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33957 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33958 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33961 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33962 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33963 space after input continuations is ignored.
33965 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33966 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33967 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33968 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33969 header with the same name, they are all removed.
33971 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33972 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33973 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33974 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33975 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33976 used for all recipients of the message.
33978 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33979 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33980 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33981 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33982 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33983 until the message is actually being written (see section
33984 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33986 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33987 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33988 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33989 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33990 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33991 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33992 modified more than once.
33994 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33995 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33998 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33999 headers remove "Subject"
34000 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34001 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34006 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34007 .cindex "envelope sender"
34008 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34010 errors_to <some address>
34012 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34013 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34014 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34017 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34019 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34020 address if its delivery failed.
34024 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34025 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34026 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34027 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34028 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34029 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34030 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34031 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34032 which implements such a filter:
34037 domains = +local_domains
34038 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34043 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34044 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34045 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34046 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34048 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34049 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34050 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34051 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34053 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34054 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34055 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34062 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34063 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34065 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34066 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34067 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34068 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34069 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34070 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34071 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34072 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34074 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34075 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34076 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34077 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34078 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34080 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34081 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34082 loopback interface specially in any way.
34084 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34085 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34090 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34091 .cindex "message" "submission"
34092 .cindex "submission mode"
34093 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34094 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34095 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34096 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34098 control = submission
34100 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34101 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34102 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34103 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34104 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34105 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34107 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34108 control = submission
34110 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34111 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34112 is used to separate options. For example:
34114 control = submission/sender_retain
34116 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34117 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34118 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34119 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34120 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34121 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34122 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34124 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34125 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34128 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34130 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34131 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34132 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34133 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34135 accept authenticated = *
34136 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34137 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34138 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34140 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34141 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34142 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34144 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34146 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34149 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34151 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34152 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34153 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34154 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34156 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34157 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34158 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34159 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34160 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34161 spoof another's address.
34163 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34164 .cindex "line endings"
34165 .cindex "carriage return"
34167 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34168 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34169 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34170 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34171 use CRLF or just CR.
34173 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34174 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34175 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34176 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34177 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34178 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34179 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34180 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34184 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34186 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34189 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34190 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34193 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34194 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34195 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34196 people trying to play silly games.
34198 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34199 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34207 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34208 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34209 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34210 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34211 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34212 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34213 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34214 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34216 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34217 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34218 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34219 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34220 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34222 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34223 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34224 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34225 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34226 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34227 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34228 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34229 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34234 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34235 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34236 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34237 .cindex "sender" "address"
34238 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34239 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34240 .cindex "envelope sender"
34241 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34242 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34243 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34244 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34246 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34247 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34249 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34250 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34251 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34252 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34253 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34254 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34255 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34256 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34257 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34259 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34260 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34261 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34262 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34263 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34264 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34265 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34267 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34268 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34269 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34271 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34272 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34273 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34274 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34278 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34279 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34280 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34281 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34282 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34283 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34284 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34285 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34288 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34289 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34292 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34293 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34297 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34298 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34300 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34301 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34302 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34304 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34307 For a locally-submitted message,
34308 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34309 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34310 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34311 included in log lines in this case.
34313 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34314 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34320 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34321 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34322 includes the header line:
34324 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34327 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34328 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34329 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34330 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34331 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34332 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34335 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34336 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34337 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34338 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34339 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34340 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34342 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34343 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34344 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34345 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34346 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34347 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34348 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34349 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34353 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34354 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34355 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34356 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34357 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34358 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34359 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34360 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34361 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34365 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34366 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34367 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34368 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34369 .cindex "message" "submission"
34370 .cindex "submission mode"
34371 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34372 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34375 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34376 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34378 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34379 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34381 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34382 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34383 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34385 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34386 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34388 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34389 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34393 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34395 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34396 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34397 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34398 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34399 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34400 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34401 &%qualify_domain%&.
34403 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34404 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34405 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34406 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34409 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34410 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34411 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34412 .cindex "message" "submission"
34413 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34414 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34415 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34416 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34417 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34418 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34419 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34420 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34421 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34422 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34425 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34426 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34427 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34428 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34429 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34430 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34432 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34433 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34434 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34435 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34437 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34438 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34439 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34442 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34443 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34444 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34445 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34446 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34447 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34448 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34449 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34450 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34451 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34452 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34453 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34457 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34458 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34459 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34460 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34461 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34462 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34463 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34464 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34465 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34469 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34470 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34471 .cindex "message" "submission"
34472 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34473 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34474 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34475 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34476 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34479 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34480 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34481 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34482 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34483 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34484 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34485 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34486 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34487 line is added to the message.
34489 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34490 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34491 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34492 options true at the same time.
34494 .cindex "submission mode"
34495 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34496 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34497 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34498 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34500 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34501 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34502 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34503 created as follows:
34506 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34507 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34508 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34510 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34511 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34513 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34514 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34517 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34518 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34519 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34520 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34522 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34523 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34524 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34525 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34529 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34530 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34531 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34532 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34533 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34534 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34535 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34536 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34537 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34539 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34540 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34541 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34542 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34543 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34544 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34546 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34547 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34548 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34550 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34551 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34552 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34554 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34555 X-added-second: another added header line
34557 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34559 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34560 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34561 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34563 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34564 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34565 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34566 not part of the names. For example:
34568 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34571 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34572 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34573 Each item is separately expanded.
34574 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34575 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34576 will act as list separators.
34578 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34579 items are expanded at routing time,
34580 and then associated with all addresses that are
34581 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34582 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34583 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34585 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34586 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34587 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34588 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34590 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34591 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34592 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34595 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34596 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34597 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34598 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34599 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34600 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34601 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34603 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34604 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34605 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34606 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34608 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34609 the following consequences:
34612 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34613 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34614 to it, at all times.
34616 Header lines that are added by a router's
34617 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34618 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34620 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34621 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34623 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34624 a later router or by a transport.
34626 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34627 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34629 headers_remove = subject
34630 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34634 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34635 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34641 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34642 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34643 .cindex "constructed address"
34644 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34647 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34651 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34653 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34654 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34655 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34656 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34657 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34658 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34659 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34660 there is no password file entry.
34663 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34664 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34665 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34666 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34667 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34668 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34669 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34670 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34674 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34675 .cindex "case of local parts"
34676 .cindex "local part" "case of"
34677 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34678 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34679 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34680 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34681 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34682 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34685 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
34686 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34687 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34688 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34689 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34693 domains = +local_domains
34694 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34695 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34698 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34699 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34700 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34701 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34702 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34706 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34707 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
34708 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
34709 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34710 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34711 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34712 empty components for compatibility.
34716 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34717 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34718 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34719 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34720 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34721 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34723 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34724 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34725 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34726 example, a header such as
34730 might get rewritten as
34732 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34734 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34735 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34738 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34739 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34740 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34741 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34742 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34743 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34744 .ecindex IIDmesproc
34748 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34749 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34751 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34752 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34753 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34754 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34755 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34756 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34757 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34760 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34762 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34764 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34767 For mail delivery, the following are available:
34770 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34772 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34775 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34778 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34779 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34782 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34783 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34784 used to contain the envelope information.
34788 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34789 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34790 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34791 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34792 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34795 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34796 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34797 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34798 processing is the same in both cases.
34800 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34801 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34802 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34803 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34804 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34805 .cindex "transport" "filter"
34806 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34807 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34810 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34811 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34812 required for the transaction.
34814 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34815 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34816 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34817 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34818 is called for verification.
34820 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34821 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34822 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34824 .cindex "carriage return"
34826 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34827 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34828 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34831 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34832 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34833 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34834 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34835 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34836 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34837 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34838 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34839 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34841 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34842 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34843 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34844 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34846 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34847 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34848 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34849 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34851 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34852 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34853 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34854 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34855 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34856 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34857 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34858 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34859 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34860 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34862 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34863 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34865 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34866 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34867 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34868 square bracket of the IP address.
34873 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34874 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34875 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34876 .cindex "host" "error"
34877 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34878 message errors, and recipient errors.
34881 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34882 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34883 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34886 Connection refused or timed out,
34888 Any error response code on connection,
34890 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34892 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34894 I/O errors at any time,
34896 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34897 the &"."& at the end of the data.
34900 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34901 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34902 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34903 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34904 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34905 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34906 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34907 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34909 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34910 .cindex "message" "error"
34911 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34912 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34913 message errors are:
34916 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34919 Timeout after MAIL,
34921 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34922 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34923 connection at any other time.
34926 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34927 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34928 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34929 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34930 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34931 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34932 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34933 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34934 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34935 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34937 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34938 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34939 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34942 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34943 .cindex "recipient" "error"
34944 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34945 recipient errors are:
34948 Any error response to RCPT,
34950 Timeout after RCPT.
34953 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34954 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34955 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34956 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34957 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34958 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34959 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34960 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34961 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34962 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34963 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34964 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34965 the retry clock is reset.
34967 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34968 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34969 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34970 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34971 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34972 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34973 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34974 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34975 recipient's retry time.
34978 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34979 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34980 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34981 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34982 until the next delivery attempt.
34984 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34985 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34986 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34987 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34988 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34991 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34992 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34993 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34994 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34995 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34996 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34997 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34999 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35000 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35001 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35002 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35003 then to be treated as a host error.
35005 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35006 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35007 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35008 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35009 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35014 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35015 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35016 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35019 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35020 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35021 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35023 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35025 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35026 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35027 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35028 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35029 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35030 stream and exits with an error code.
35032 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35033 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35034 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35035 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35037 .cindex "carriage return"
35039 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35040 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35041 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35043 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35044 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35045 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35047 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35048 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35049 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35050 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35051 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35052 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35053 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35054 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35056 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35057 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35058 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35059 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35060 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35061 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35062 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35063 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35064 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35066 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35067 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35068 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35070 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35071 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35072 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35073 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35074 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35076 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35077 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35078 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35079 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35080 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35081 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35082 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35084 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35085 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35086 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35087 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35088 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35090 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35091 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35092 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35093 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35094 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35095 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35096 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35097 a delivery process.
35099 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35100 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35101 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35102 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35103 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35105 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35106 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35107 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35108 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35110 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35111 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35112 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35116 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35117 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35118 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35119 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35120 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35121 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35122 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35123 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35126 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35127 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35128 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35129 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35130 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35131 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35132 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35133 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35134 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35135 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35136 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35140 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35141 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35142 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35143 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35144 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35145 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35146 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35147 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35149 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35150 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35151 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35152 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35153 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35156 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35157 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35158 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35160 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35161 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35162 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35163 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35164 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35169 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35170 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35171 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35172 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35174 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35175 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35176 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35177 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35178 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35179 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35180 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35181 SMTP response codes.
35183 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35184 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35185 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35186 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35187 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35188 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35189 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35190 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35195 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35196 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35197 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35198 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35199 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35200 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35201 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35203 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35204 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35205 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35206 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35207 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35208 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35209 argument. For example,
35217 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35218 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35219 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35220 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35221 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35223 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35224 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35225 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35226 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35227 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35228 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35229 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35230 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35232 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35233 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35234 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35235 whatever the form of its argument. For
35238 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35239 $sender_host_address
35241 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35242 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35243 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35244 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35245 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35246 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35247 for it to change them before running the command.
35251 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35252 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35253 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35254 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35255 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35256 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35257 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35258 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35259 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35260 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35261 runs for RCPT commands:
35265 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35269 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35270 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35271 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35272 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35273 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35274 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35275 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35276 envelope along with the message.
35278 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35279 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35280 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35281 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35282 can be used to specify it.
35284 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35285 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35286 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35287 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35288 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35291 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35292 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35293 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35298 driver = manualroute
35299 transport = smtp_appendfile
35300 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35304 driver = appendfile
35305 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35310 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35311 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35312 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35316 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35317 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35318 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35319 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35320 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35321 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35322 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35323 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35324 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35325 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35327 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35328 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35330 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35331 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35332 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35333 make some use of automatically, for example:
35335 554 Unexpected end of file
35336 Transaction started in line 10
35337 Error detected in line 14
35339 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35342 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35343 The error message was:
35345 501 '>' missing at end of address
35347 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35348 The error was detected in line 12.
35349 The SMTP command at fault was:
35351 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35353 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35354 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35356 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35357 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35359 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35360 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35367 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35368 "Customizing messages"
35369 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35370 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35371 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35372 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35373 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35375 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35376 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35377 option. Exim also adds the line
35379 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35381 to all warning and bounce messages,
35384 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35385 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35386 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35387 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35388 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35389 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35390 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35392 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35393 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35394 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35395 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35396 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35399 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35400 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35401 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35402 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35403 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35404 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35405 option, rounded to a whole number.
35407 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35410 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35411 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35413 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35414 failing addresses with their error messages.
35416 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35417 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35419 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35420 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35423 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35424 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35425 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35427 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35428 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35429 {: returning message to sender}}
35431 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35433 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35434 {that you sent }{sent by
35438 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35439 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35441 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35443 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35446 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35448 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35451 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35452 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35453 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35454 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35455 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35459 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35460 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35462 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35463 the delayed addresses.
35465 The third item then ends the message.
35468 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35469 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35471 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35472 $warn_message_delay
35474 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35476 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35477 {that you sent }{sent by
35481 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35482 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35484 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35485 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35486 The date of the message is: $h_date
35488 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35490 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35491 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35492 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35493 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35494 the message will be returned to you.
35496 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35497 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35498 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35499 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35500 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35501 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35502 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35503 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35512 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35513 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35514 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35518 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35519 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35520 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35521 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35522 routing explicitly:
35524 send_to_smart_host:
35525 driver = manualroute
35526 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35527 transport = remote_smtp
35529 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35530 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35531 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35532 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35533 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35538 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35539 .cindex "mailing lists"
35540 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35541 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35542 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35544 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35545 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35546 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35547 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35551 domains = lists.example
35552 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35555 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35558 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35559 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35560 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35561 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35563 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35564 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35567 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35568 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35569 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35570 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35571 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35573 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35574 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35575 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35576 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35577 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35578 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35579 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35580 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35581 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35585 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35586 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35587 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35588 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35589 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35590 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35591 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35593 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35594 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35595 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35596 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35597 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35601 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35602 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35603 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35604 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35605 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35606 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35607 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35608 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35609 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35610 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35612 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35613 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35614 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35615 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35616 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35617 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35618 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35619 pre-existing messages.
35621 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35622 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35623 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35624 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35625 one level of expansion anyway.
35629 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35630 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35631 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35632 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35633 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35634 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35636 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35637 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35641 domains = lists.example
35642 local_part_suffix = -request
35643 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35648 domains = lists.example
35649 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35650 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35651 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35654 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35659 domains = lists.example
35661 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35663 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35664 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35665 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35668 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35669 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35670 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35671 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35672 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35673 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35674 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35675 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35676 &"unrouteable address"& error.
35678 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35679 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35680 the address, giving a suitable error message.
35685 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35687 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35688 .cindex "envelope sender"
35689 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35690 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35691 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35692 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35693 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35694 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35696 .oindex &%errors_to%&
35697 .oindex &%return_path%&
35698 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35699 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35700 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35701 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35702 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35703 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35704 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35710 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35711 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35713 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35714 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35715 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35716 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35717 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35718 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35719 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35722 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35724 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
35725 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35726 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35727 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35728 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35729 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35731 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35732 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35733 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35734 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35738 domains = ! +local_domains
35740 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35741 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35744 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35745 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35746 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35747 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35750 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35751 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35752 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35753 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35754 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35758 domains = ! +local_domains
35759 transport = remote_smtp
35761 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35762 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35765 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35766 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35767 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35768 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35771 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35772 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35773 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35774 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35775 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35776 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35784 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35785 .cindex "virtual domains"
35786 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
35787 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35791 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35792 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35793 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35795 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35796 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35797 have login accounts on that host.
35800 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35801 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35802 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35803 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35804 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35805 to a router of this form:
35809 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35810 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35813 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35814 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35815 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35816 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35817 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35818 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35820 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35821 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35822 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35823 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35825 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35826 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35827 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35831 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35832 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35833 transport = my_mailboxes
35835 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35836 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35837 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35838 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35839 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35843 driver = appendfile
35844 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35847 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35848 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35850 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35851 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35852 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35853 information about the domains.
35857 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35858 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35859 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35860 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
35861 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
35862 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35863 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35864 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35865 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35866 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35867 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35868 example, consider this router:
35873 file = $home/.forward
35874 local_part_suffix = -*
35875 local_part_suffix_optional
35878 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35879 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35880 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35881 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35883 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35884 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35887 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35888 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35889 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35890 control over which suffixes are valid.
35892 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35893 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35899 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35900 local_part_suffix = -*
35901 local_part_suffix_optional
35904 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35905 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35906 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35907 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35908 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35912 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35913 .cindex "vacation processing"
35914 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35915 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35916 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35917 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35918 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35921 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35922 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35923 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35924 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35926 spqr, vacation-spqr
35929 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35930 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35931 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35932 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35933 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35937 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35938 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35942 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35943 .cindex "message" "copying every"
35944 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35945 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35946 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35947 each day's messages.
35949 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35950 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35951 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35952 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35956 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35957 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35958 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35959 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35960 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35961 permanently connected.
35963 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35964 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35965 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35968 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35969 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35970 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35971 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35972 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35973 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35974 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35975 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35977 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35978 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35979 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35980 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35981 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35982 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35985 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35986 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35987 intermittent host. For example:
35989 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35991 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35992 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35993 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35994 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35995 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35996 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35999 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36000 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36001 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36002 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36003 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36004 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36005 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36009 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36010 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36011 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36012 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36013 delivered immediately.
36015 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36016 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36017 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36018 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36019 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36020 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36021 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36022 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36023 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36024 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36025 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36026 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36027 single SMTP connection.
36031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36034 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36035 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36036 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36037 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36038 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36039 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36040 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36041 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36042 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36043 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36046 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36047 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36048 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36049 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36050 email is not desirable.
36052 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36053 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36054 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36055 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36056 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36057 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36058 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36060 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36061 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36062 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36063 before sending a message to the smart host.
36065 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36066 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36067 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36069 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36070 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36071 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36072 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36073 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36074 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36075 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36077 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36081 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36082 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36084 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36085 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36086 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36087 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36088 successful, a zero return code is given.
36090 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36091 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36092 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36093 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36094 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36097 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36098 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36099 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36101 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36102 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36103 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36104 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36105 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36107 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36108 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36109 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36111 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36112 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36113 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36114 are ever generated.
36116 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36118 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36119 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36120 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36123 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36124 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36125 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36126 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36127 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36128 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36136 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36137 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36138 .cindex "log" "types of"
36139 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36144 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36145 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36146 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36147 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36148 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36149 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36150 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36151 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36153 .cindex "reject log"
36154 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36155 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36156 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36157 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36158 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36159 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36160 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36161 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36162 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36165 .cindex "panic log"
36166 .cindex "system log"
36167 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36168 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36169 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36170 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36171 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36172 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36173 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36174 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36175 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36178 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36179 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36180 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36182 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36185 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36186 ways of changing this:
36189 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36194 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36196 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36199 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36203 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36204 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36205 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36206 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36207 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36208 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36213 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36214 .cindex "log" "destination"
36215 .cindex "log" "to file"
36216 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36218 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36219 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36220 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36221 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36222 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36223 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36224 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36226 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36227 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
36228 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36229 references to the host name:
36231 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36233 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36234 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
36235 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36236 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36237 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36240 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36241 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36242 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36243 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36244 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36245 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36246 implying the use of a default path.
36248 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36249 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36250 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36251 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36252 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36253 equivalent to the setting:
36255 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36257 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
36258 or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36259 that is where the logs are written.
36261 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
36262 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36264 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36266 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36267 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36268 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36269 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36271 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36276 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36277 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36278 .cindex "cycling logs"
36279 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36280 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36281 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36282 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36283 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36284 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36285 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36287 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36288 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36289 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36290 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36291 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36292 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36293 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36294 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36295 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36296 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36297 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36302 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36303 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36304 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36305 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36306 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36307 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36308 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36309 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36311 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36312 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36313 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36314 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36316 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36317 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36319 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36320 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36321 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36322 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36324 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36325 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36326 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36327 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36329 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36330 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36331 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36332 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36333 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36334 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36337 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36338 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36339 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36340 /var/log/exim/panic
36344 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36345 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36346 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36347 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36348 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36349 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36350 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36351 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36352 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36353 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36354 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36355 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36356 the time and host name to each line.
36357 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36360 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36362 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36364 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36367 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36368 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36369 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36370 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36372 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36373 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36374 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36375 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36376 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36377 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36378 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36379 RFC 3164, you should set
36381 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36383 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36384 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36386 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36387 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36388 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36389 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36390 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36391 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36392 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36393 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36394 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36396 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36397 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36398 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36399 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36402 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36405 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36406 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36407 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36408 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36410 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36411 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36412 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36413 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36414 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36415 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36417 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36418 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36419 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36422 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36424 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36425 without modification.
36427 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36428 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36429 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36434 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36435 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36436 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36437 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36438 timestamp. The flags are:
36440 &`<=`& message arrival
36441 &`(=`& message fakereject
36442 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36443 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36444 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36445 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36446 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36447 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36451 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36452 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36453 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36454 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36455 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36457 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36458 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36459 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36461 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36462 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36463 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36467 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36471 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36472 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36473 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36474 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36475 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36476 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36477 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36478 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36479 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36480 name in parentheses.
36482 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36483 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36484 the log containing text like these examples:
36486 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36487 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36489 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36492 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36493 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36496 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36497 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36498 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36499 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36500 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36501 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36502 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36503 suite that was used.
36505 .cindex log protocol
36506 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36507 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36508 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36509 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36510 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36511 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36512 authenticator name.
36514 .cindex "size" "of message"
36515 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36516 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36517 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36518 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36521 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36522 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36526 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36527 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36528 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36529 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36530 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36531 to fit it on the page:
36533 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36534 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36535 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36536 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36537 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36539 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36540 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36541 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36542 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36543 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36545 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36546 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36547 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36548 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36550 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36551 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36553 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36555 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36556 parentheses afterwards.
36558 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36559 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36560 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36561 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36562 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36563 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36564 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36565 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36566 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36567 TLS cipher information is still available.
36569 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36570 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36571 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36572 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36573 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36575 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36576 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36578 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36579 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36582 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36583 .cindex "discarded messages"
36584 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36585 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36586 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36587 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36589 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36590 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36592 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36593 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36595 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36596 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36600 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36601 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36603 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36604 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36606 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36607 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36608 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36610 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36611 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36613 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36614 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36615 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36619 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36620 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36621 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36622 following form is logged:
36624 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36625 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36627 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36628 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36630 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36631 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36632 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36633 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36634 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36636 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36637 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36638 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36639 flagged with &`**`&.
36643 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36644 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36645 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36646 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36647 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36651 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36654 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36656 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36657 at the end of its processing.
36662 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36663 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36664 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36665 the following table:
36667 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36668 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36669 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36670 &`CV `& certificate verification status
36671 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36672 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36673 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36674 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36675 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36676 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36677 &`H `& host name and IP address
36678 &`I `& local interface used
36679 &`id `& message id for incoming message
36680 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36681 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
36682 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36683 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36684 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36685 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36686 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36687 &`Q `& alternate queue name
36688 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36689 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36690 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36691 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36692 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36693 &`S `& size of message in bytes
36694 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36695 &`ST `& shadow transport name
36696 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36697 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36698 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36699 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36700 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
36704 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36705 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36706 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36709 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36710 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36711 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36712 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36713 during the first delivery attempt.
36715 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36716 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36717 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36719 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36720 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36721 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36722 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36723 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36726 .cindex "error" "ignored"
36727 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36730 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36731 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36733 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36734 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36736 A delivery set up by a router configured with
36737 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36738 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36742 failed. The delivery was discarded.
36745 .cindex DKIM "log line"
36746 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36747 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36754 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36755 .cindex "log" "selectors"
36756 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36757 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36758 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36761 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36763 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36764 selection marked by asterisks:
36766 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36767 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36768 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36769 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36770 &` arguments `& command line arguments
36771 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36772 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36773 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36774 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36775 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36776 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36777 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36778 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36779 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36780 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36781 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36782 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36783 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36784 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36785 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36786 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36787 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36788 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36789 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36790 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36791 &` pid `& Exim process id
36792 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
36793 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36794 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
36795 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36796 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36797 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36798 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36799 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36800 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36801 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36802 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36803 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36804 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36805 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36806 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36807 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36808 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36809 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36810 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36811 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36812 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36813 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36814 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36815 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36816 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36818 &` all `& all of the above
36820 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36821 section &<<SECID99>>&
36823 More details on each of these items follows:
36827 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36828 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36829 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36830 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36831 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36832 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36834 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36835 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36836 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36837 this log selector is set.
36839 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
36840 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36841 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36842 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36843 such users cannot access the log).
36845 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
36846 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36847 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36848 parentheses between them.
36850 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36851 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36852 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36853 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36854 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36855 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36856 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36857 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36858 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36859 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36860 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36861 between the caller and Exim.
36863 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36864 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36865 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36867 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36868 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36869 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36870 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36871 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36872 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36874 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36875 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36876 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36877 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36878 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36880 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36881 .cindex "size" "of message"
36882 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36883 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36885 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36886 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36887 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36888 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36890 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
36891 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36892 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36894 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36895 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36896 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
36897 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36898 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36901 .cindex dnssec logging
36902 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36903 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36904 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36905 It does not cover helo-name verification.
36906 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36908 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36909 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36910 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36911 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36912 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36913 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36915 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36916 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36917 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36918 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36919 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36921 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36922 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36923 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36924 client's ident port times out.
36926 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36927 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36928 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36929 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36930 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36931 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36932 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36933 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36934 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36935 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36936 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36938 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36939 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36940 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36941 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36942 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36943 on a proxied connection
36944 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36945 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36947 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36948 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
36949 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36950 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36951 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36952 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36953 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36954 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36955 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36956 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36957 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36959 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36960 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36961 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36963 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36964 .cindex millisecond logging
36965 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36966 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36967 appended to the seconds value.
36969 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36970 .cindex "log" "local interface"
36971 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
36972 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36973 .cindex "interface" "logging"
36974 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36975 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36976 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36977 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36979 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36980 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36981 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36982 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36983 containing => tags) following the IP address.
36984 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36985 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36986 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36987 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36988 local port is a random ephemeral port.
36990 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36991 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36992 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36993 immediately after the time and date.
36996 .cindex log pipelining
36997 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
36998 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
36999 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37000 The field is a single "L".
37002 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37003 the field has a minus appended.
37005 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37006 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37007 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37009 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37010 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37011 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37012 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37013 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37014 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37015 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37016 message has been successfully received.
37017 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37018 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37020 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37021 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37022 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37023 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37025 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37026 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37027 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37028 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37029 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37031 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37032 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37033 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37034 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37035 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37037 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37040 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37041 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37042 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37043 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37045 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37046 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37047 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37048 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37049 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37051 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37052 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37053 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37054 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37057 .cindex "log" "return path"
37058 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37059 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37060 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37061 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37063 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37064 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37065 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37066 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37067 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37069 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37070 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37071 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37072 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37075 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37076 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37079 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37080 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37081 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37082 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37084 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37085 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37087 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37088 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37089 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37090 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37091 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37092 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37095 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37096 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37097 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37098 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37099 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37100 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37101 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37102 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37103 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37104 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37106 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37107 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37108 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37109 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37110 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37111 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37112 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37113 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37115 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37116 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37117 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37118 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37119 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37120 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37122 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37123 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37124 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37125 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37126 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37127 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37128 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37129 already have their own log lines.
37131 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37132 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37133 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37134 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37135 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37136 the same logging options.
37138 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37139 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37143 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37144 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37145 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37146 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37147 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37149 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37150 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37151 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37152 was accepted or used.
37154 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37155 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37156 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37157 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37158 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37159 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37160 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37161 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37163 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37164 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37165 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37166 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37167 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37168 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37169 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37170 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37171 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37173 .cindex "log" "subject"
37174 .cindex "subject, logging"
37175 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37176 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37177 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37178 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37179 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37181 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37183 .cindex DANE logging
37184 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37185 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37187 using a CA trust anchor,
37188 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37189 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37191 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37192 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37193 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37194 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37196 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37197 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37198 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37199 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37200 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37202 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37203 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37204 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37205 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37206 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37208 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37209 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37210 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37214 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37215 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37216 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37217 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37218 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37219 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37220 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37221 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37222 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37223 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37224 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37225 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37226 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37228 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37229 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37230 &%message_logs%& option false.
37236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37237 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37239 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37240 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37241 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37242 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37243 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37245 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37246 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37247 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37248 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37249 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37250 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37251 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37253 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37254 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37255 "extract statistics from the log"
37256 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37257 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37258 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37259 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37260 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37261 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37262 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37263 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37266 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37267 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37268 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37273 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37274 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37275 .cindex "process, querying"
37277 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37278 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37279 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37280 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37281 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37282 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37283 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37284 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37286 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37287 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37288 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37291 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37292 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37293 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37294 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37295 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37298 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37299 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37300 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37301 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37303 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37305 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37306 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37307 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37308 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37309 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37310 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37312 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37313 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37317 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37318 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37319 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37320 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37324 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37328 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37329 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37331 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37332 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37335 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37336 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37337 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37341 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37342 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37343 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37345 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37346 Match against the size field.
37348 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37349 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37351 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37352 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37355 Match only frozen messages.
37358 Match only non-frozen messages.
37361 The following options control the format of the output:
37365 Display only the count of matching messages.
37368 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37372 Display message ids only.
37375 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37378 Display messages in reverse order.
37381 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37384 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37388 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37389 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37390 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37391 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37392 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37393 running a command such as
37395 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37397 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37398 it, as in the following example:
37400 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37402 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37403 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37404 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37405 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37407 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37408 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37409 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37410 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37411 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37412 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37415 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37416 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37417 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37418 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37419 level"& addresses).
37424 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37426 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37427 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37428 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37429 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37430 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37431 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37432 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37433 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37434 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37435 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37437 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37439 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37441 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37442 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37443 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37445 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37446 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37447 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37448 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37449 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37451 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37452 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37453 regular expression.
37455 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37456 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37458 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37459 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37463 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37464 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37465 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37466 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37467 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37468 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37471 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37472 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37473 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37474 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37475 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37478 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37479 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37480 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37481 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37482 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37483 the &%--help%& option.
37486 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37487 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37488 .cindex "cycling logs"
37489 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37490 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37491 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37492 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37493 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37494 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37495 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37497 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37498 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37500 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37501 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37502 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37506 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37507 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37508 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37509 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37510 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37511 logs are handled similarly.
37513 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37514 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37515 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37516 any existing log files.
37518 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37519 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37520 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37521 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37522 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37524 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37526 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37527 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37531 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37532 .cindex "statistics"
37533 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37534 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37535 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37536 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
37537 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
37539 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37540 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37541 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37542 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37543 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37545 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37547 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37548 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37549 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37550 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37551 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37552 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37553 also produced per user.
37555 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37556 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37557 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37558 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37559 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37561 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37562 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37563 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37564 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37565 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37566 an entirely separate message.
37568 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37569 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37570 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37571 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37572 least one address that failed.
37574 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37575 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37576 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37577 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37578 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37579 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37580 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37582 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37583 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37584 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37586 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37587 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37588 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37590 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37593 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37594 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37595 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37596 .cindex "checking access"
37597 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37598 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37599 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37600 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37601 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37602 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37604 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37605 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37607 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37609 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37610 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37611 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37612 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37615 550 Relay not permitted
37617 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37618 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37619 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37620 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37623 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37624 -f himself@there.example
37626 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37627 mandatory arguments.
37629 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37630 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37631 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37635 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37636 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37637 .cindex "building DBM files"
37638 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37639 .cindex "lower casing"
37640 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37641 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37642 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37643 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37644 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37645 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37647 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37648 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37649 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37650 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37653 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37654 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37655 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37659 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37660 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37661 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37662 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37664 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37666 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37667 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37669 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37670 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37671 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37672 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37673 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37674 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37676 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37677 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37678 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37679 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37680 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37681 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37682 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37688 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37689 .cindex "retry" "times"
37690 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
37691 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37692 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37693 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37694 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37695 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37696 output. For example:
37698 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37699 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37700 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37701 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37702 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37703 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37704 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37705 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37706 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37707 past final cutoff time
37709 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37710 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37711 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37712 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37713 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37714 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37717 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37718 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37719 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37720 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37721 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37722 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37726 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37727 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37728 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37729 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37730 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37731 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37732 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37735 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
37737 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37740 &'callout'&: the callout cache
37742 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37744 &'misc'&: other hints data
37747 The &'misc'& database is used for
37750 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37752 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37753 &(smtp)& transport)
37755 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37761 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37762 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37763 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37764 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37765 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37767 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37769 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37771 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
37772 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37774 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37775 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37776 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37777 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37778 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37779 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37780 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37781 and a textual description of the error.
37783 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37784 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37785 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37788 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37789 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37790 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37791 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37792 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37793 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37798 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37799 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37800 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37801 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37802 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37803 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37804 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37805 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37806 updated sufficiently often.
37808 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37809 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37810 the retry database:
37812 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37814 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37815 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37816 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37817 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37818 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37819 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37820 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37821 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37822 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37823 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37824 whenever it removes information from the database.
37826 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37827 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37828 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37829 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37830 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37832 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37833 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37834 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37835 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37836 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37837 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37838 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37841 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37842 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37847 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37848 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37849 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37850 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37851 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37852 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37853 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37856 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37857 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37858 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37859 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37860 by new data, for example:
37864 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37865 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37866 used as optional separators.
37871 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37872 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37873 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37874 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
37875 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37876 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37877 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37878 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37879 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37880 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37881 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37882 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37883 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37887 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37890 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37893 .vitem &%-interval%&
37894 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37895 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37897 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
37898 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37901 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37904 Suppress verification output.
37906 .vitem &%-retries%&
37907 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37908 the lock (default 10).
37910 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
37911 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37912 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37913 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37916 .vitem &%-timeout%&
37917 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37918 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37919 default), a non-blocking call is used.
37922 Generate verbose output.
37925 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37926 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37927 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37928 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37929 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37930 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37931 more than 30 minutes old.
37933 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37934 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37935 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37936 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37937 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37938 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37940 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37941 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37942 suppresses all output except error messages.
37946 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37948 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37950 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37951 <&'some commands'&>
37954 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37955 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37958 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37959 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37961 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37962 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37966 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37967 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37969 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37970 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37971 .cindex "X-windows"
37972 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
37973 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37974 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37975 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37976 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37977 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37978 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37979 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37983 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37984 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37985 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37986 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37987 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37988 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37989 parameters are for.
37991 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37992 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37993 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37995 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37997 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37998 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37999 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38000 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38001 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38003 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38004 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38006 Eximon*background: gray94
38008 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38009 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38010 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38011 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38012 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38013 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38014 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38017 Eximon*highlight: gray
38020 .cindex "admin user"
38021 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
38022 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38024 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38025 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38026 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38027 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38028 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38030 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38031 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38032 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38033 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38034 different parts of the display.
38039 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38040 .cindex "stripchart"
38041 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
38042 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38043 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38044 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38045 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38046 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38047 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38048 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38049 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38051 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38052 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38053 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38054 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38056 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38057 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38058 to a single partition.
38060 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38061 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38062 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38063 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38064 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38065 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38066 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38071 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38072 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38073 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38074 .cindex "window size"
38075 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38076 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38077 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38078 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38079 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38080 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38082 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38083 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38084 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38085 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38087 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38088 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38089 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38090 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38091 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38092 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38094 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38095 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38096 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38100 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38101 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38102 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38103 the main log is maintained.
38104 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38105 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38106 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38107 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38108 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38110 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38111 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38112 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38113 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38114 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38115 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38116 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38117 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38118 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38119 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38120 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38122 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38123 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38124 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38125 It cannot go further back up the log.
38127 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38128 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38129 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38130 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38131 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38132 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38134 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38135 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38136 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38137 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38138 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38139 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38141 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38142 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38143 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38144 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38145 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38146 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38147 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38148 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38149 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38154 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38155 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38156 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38157 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38158 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38159 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38160 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38161 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38162 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38163 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38165 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38166 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
38167 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38168 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38169 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38170 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38171 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38173 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38174 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38175 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38176 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38177 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38178 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38179 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38181 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38182 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38183 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38184 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38186 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38187 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38188 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38189 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38190 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38191 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38192 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38195 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38196 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38198 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38199 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38200 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38201 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38202 display is updated.
38206 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38207 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38208 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38209 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38210 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38213 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38214 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38215 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38216 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38217 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38219 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38221 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38225 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38226 in a new text window.
38228 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38229 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38230 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38232 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38233 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38234 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38235 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
38237 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38238 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38239 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38240 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38241 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38243 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38244 that the message be frozen.
38246 .cindex "thawing messages"
38247 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38248 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38249 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38250 that the message be thawed.
38252 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38253 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38254 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38255 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38257 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38258 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38261 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38262 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38263 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38264 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38265 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38266 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38267 which case no action is taken.
38269 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38270 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38271 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38272 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38273 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38274 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38275 case no action is taken.
38277 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38278 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38280 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38281 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38282 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38283 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38284 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38285 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38286 the address is qualified with that domain.
38289 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38290 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38291 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38292 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38293 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38294 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38295 if no output is generated.
38297 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38298 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38299 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38300 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38302 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38303 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38304 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38314 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38315 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38316 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38317 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38319 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38320 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38321 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38322 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38323 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38324 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38326 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38327 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38328 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38329 as soon as possible.
38332 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38333 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38334 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38335 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38336 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38337 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38340 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38341 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38342 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38343 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38344 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38345 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38347 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38348 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38349 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38350 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38353 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38354 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38355 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38356 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38357 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38358 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38359 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38360 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38361 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38365 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38366 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38367 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38368 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38369 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38370 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38371 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38373 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38376 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38377 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38378 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38379 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38380 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38385 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38387 .cindex "root privilege"
38388 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38389 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38390 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38391 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38392 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38393 is required for two things:
38396 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38397 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38400 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38401 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38405 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38406 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38407 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38408 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38409 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38410 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38411 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38412 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38414 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38415 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38416 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38418 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38419 uid and gid in the following cases:
38424 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38425 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38426 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38427 the calling process.
38428 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38429 option may not be used at all.
38430 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38431 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38432 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38437 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38438 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38441 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38442 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38443 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38444 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38445 testing address verification
38448 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38451 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38452 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38455 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38458 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38459 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38460 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38461 will be used during message reception.
38463 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38464 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38466 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38467 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38468 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38469 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38470 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38471 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38472 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38473 generating bounce and warning messages.
38475 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38476 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38477 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38478 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38480 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38481 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38487 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38488 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38489 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38490 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38491 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38492 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38493 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38494 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38495 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38496 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38500 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38501 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38502 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38503 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38505 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38506 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38507 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38508 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38509 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38511 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38512 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38513 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38516 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38517 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38518 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38520 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38521 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38522 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38523 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38524 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38525 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38526 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38527 address this problem at this time.
38529 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38530 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38531 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38532 be used in the most straightforward way.
38534 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38535 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38538 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38539 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38540 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38541 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38542 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38544 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38545 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38547 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38548 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38549 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38550 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38552 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38553 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38556 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38557 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38558 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38560 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38561 owned by the Exim user.
38563 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38564 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38565 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38570 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38571 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38572 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38573 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38575 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38576 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38581 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38582 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38583 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38587 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38588 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38589 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38590 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38591 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38592 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38593 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38596 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38597 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38598 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38599 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38600 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38602 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38603 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38604 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38605 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38606 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38607 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38608 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38610 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38611 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38612 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38614 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38615 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38617 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38618 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38619 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38621 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38622 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38623 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38625 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38626 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38627 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38628 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38634 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38635 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38636 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38637 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38638 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38639 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38640 are some issues to be aware of:
38643 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38645 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38647 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38648 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38649 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38650 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38651 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38652 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38655 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38656 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38657 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38659 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38660 expected to yield one result.
38666 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38667 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38668 .cindex "IP source routing"
38669 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38670 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38671 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38672 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38676 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38677 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38678 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38683 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38684 .cindex "trusted users"
38685 .cindex "admin user"
38686 .cindex "privileged user"
38687 .cindex "user" "trusted"
38688 .cindex "user" "admin"
38689 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38690 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38691 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38692 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38693 permit a remote host to be specified.
38696 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38697 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38698 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38699 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38700 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38701 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38703 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38704 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38705 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38706 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38707 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38709 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38710 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38711 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38712 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38713 includes the contents of files on the spool.
38717 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38718 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38719 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38720 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38721 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38722 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38724 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38725 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38726 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38727 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38728 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38729 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38732 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38733 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38734 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38735 This affects most of the checking options,
38736 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38739 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38740 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
38741 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38742 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38743 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38744 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38748 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38749 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38750 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38751 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38752 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38757 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38758 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38759 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38760 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38765 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38766 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38767 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38768 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38769 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38773 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38774 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38775 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38779 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38780 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38781 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38782 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38783 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38784 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38785 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38787 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38788 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38793 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38794 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38795 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38796 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38800 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38801 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38802 enough to hold the result.
38803 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
38808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38809 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38811 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38812 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38813 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38814 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38815 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
38816 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38817 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38818 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38819 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38820 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38821 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38822 themselves are recoverable.
38825 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
38826 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
38827 and should not be used as such.
38830 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38831 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38832 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38835 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38836 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38837 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38838 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38839 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38841 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38842 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38843 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38844 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38846 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38848 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38851 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38853 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38854 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38855 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38856 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38857 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38858 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38859 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38860 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38863 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38864 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38865 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38866 relics of crashes and can be removed.
38868 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38869 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38870 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38871 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38872 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38873 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38874 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38875 normally the Exim user.
38877 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38878 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38879 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38880 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38881 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38882 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38883 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38884 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38886 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38887 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38888 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38889 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38891 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38892 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38895 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38896 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38897 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38898 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38899 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38900 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38901 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38902 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38903 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38906 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38907 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38908 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38909 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38910 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38911 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38913 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38914 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38915 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38916 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38917 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38918 character. It may contain internal newlines.
38920 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38921 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38922 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38924 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38925 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38926 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38927 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38928 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38930 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38931 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38932 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38933 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38934 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38936 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38937 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38938 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38940 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38941 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38942 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38944 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38945 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38946 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38948 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38949 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38950 present if the number is greater than zero.
38952 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38953 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38954 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38956 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38957 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38958 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38960 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38961 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38964 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38965 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38966 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38969 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38970 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38971 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38972 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38974 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38975 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38976 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38978 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38979 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38980 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38981 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38982 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38983 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38985 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38986 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38987 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38988 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38989 supplied by the remote host, if any.
38991 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38992 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38993 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38994 generated messages.
38997 The message is from a local sender.
38999 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39000 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39002 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39003 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39004 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39005 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39007 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39008 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39009 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39012 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39013 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39016 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39017 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39018 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39020 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39021 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39022 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39024 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39025 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39026 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39028 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39029 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39030 rather than Unix-format.
39031 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39032 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39034 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39035 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39036 certificate was verified by the server.
39038 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39039 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39040 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39042 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39043 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39044 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39048 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39049 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39050 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39051 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39052 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39053 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39054 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39055 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39056 addresses are complete.
39058 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39059 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39060 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39061 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39062 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39063 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39065 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39066 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39067 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39069 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39070 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39071 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39072 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39076 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39077 darcy@austen.fict.example
39079 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39081 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39082 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39083 line is of the following form:
39085 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39086 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39088 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39089 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39090 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39091 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39092 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39093 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39094 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39095 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39098 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39099 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39100 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39101 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39102 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39106 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39107 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39108 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39109 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39110 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39111 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39112 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39113 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39114 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39115 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39118 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39119 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39120 typical set of headers:
39122 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39123 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39124 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39125 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39126 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39127 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39128 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39129 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39130 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39131 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39132 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39134 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39135 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39136 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39137 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39138 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39139 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39141 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39142 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39143 an ASCII newline character.
39144 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39145 can have an alternate format.
39146 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39147 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39148 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39149 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39150 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39151 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39156 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39157 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39160 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39162 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39163 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39164 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39165 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39167 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39168 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39169 any original DKIM signature.
39171 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39172 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39174 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39176 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39177 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39178 (including transport filters)
39179 except cutthrough delivery.
39181 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39182 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39183 different signature contexts.
39186 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39187 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39188 Exim's standard controls.
39190 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39191 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39193 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39194 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39195 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39196 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39198 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39199 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39200 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39201 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39204 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39205 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39206 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39207 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39211 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39212 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39214 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39215 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39217 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39219 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39220 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39223 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39224 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39225 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39226 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39227 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39229 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39230 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39232 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39233 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39234 After expansion, this can be a list.
39235 Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39236 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39237 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39238 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39240 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39241 This sets the key selector string.
39242 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39243 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39244 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39245 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39246 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39247 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39249 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39250 This sets the private key to use.
39251 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39252 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39253 The result can either
39255 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39257 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39258 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39260 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39263 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39264 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39268 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39270 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39271 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39273 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39274 for the DNS TXT record.
39275 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39279 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39280 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39283 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39285 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39286 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39289 Support for EC keys is being developed under
39290 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
39291 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39292 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39293 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39294 for some transition period.
39295 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39298 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39300 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39301 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39304 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39306 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39307 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39310 Note that the format
39311 of Ed25519 keys in DNS has not yet been decided; this release supports
39312 both of the leading candidates at this time, a future release will
39313 probably drop support for whichever proposal loses.
39315 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39316 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39318 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39320 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39322 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39325 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39327 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39330 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39331 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39332 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39333 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39334 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39335 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39337 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39338 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39339 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39340 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39341 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39343 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39344 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39345 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39346 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39347 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39350 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39351 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39352 list of header names.
39353 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39354 in the message signature.
39355 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39356 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39357 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39358 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39360 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39361 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39362 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39364 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39365 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39367 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39368 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39369 name will be appended.
39372 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39373 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39374 If not set, no such information will be included.
39375 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39377 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39378 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39380 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39384 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39385 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39388 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39389 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39390 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39391 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39392 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39395 .new The results of that verification are then made available to the
39396 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, &new(which can examine and modify them).
39397 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39398 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39399 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39400 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39401 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39402 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39404 To evaluate the &new(verification result) in the ACL
39405 a large number of expansion variables
39406 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39407 runtime of the ACL.
39409 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39410 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39411 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39412 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39414 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39415 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39416 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39417 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39418 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39419 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39422 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39424 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39425 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39426 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39428 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39430 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39431 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39432 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39434 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39437 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39438 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39440 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39441 for each matching signature.
39444 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39445 available (from most to least important):
39449 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39450 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39451 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39452 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39454 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39455 Within the DKIM ACL,
39456 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39458 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39459 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39461 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39462 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39464 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39465 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39467 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39470 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39471 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39472 hash-method or key-size:
39474 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39475 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39476 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39477 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39478 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39479 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39480 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39483 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39484 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39485 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39486 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39488 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39489 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39490 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39492 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39493 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39495 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39496 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39498 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39499 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39500 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39502 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39503 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39504 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39505 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39508 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39510 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39511 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39512 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39513 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39515 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39516 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39517 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39518 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39520 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39521 The key record selector string.
39523 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39524 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39525 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39526 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39527 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39530 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39532 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39534 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39535 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39538 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39539 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39541 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39542 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39544 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39545 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39547 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39548 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39549 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39550 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39551 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39552 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39554 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39555 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39556 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39557 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39559 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39560 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39561 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39562 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39565 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39566 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39567 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39569 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39570 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39571 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39572 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39573 integer size comparisons against this value.
39574 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39576 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39577 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39579 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39580 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39582 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39583 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39585 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39586 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39589 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39590 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39593 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39594 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39596 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39597 Number of bits in the key.
39599 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39601 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39602 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39605 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39606 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39607 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39611 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39614 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39615 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39616 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39617 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39618 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39621 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39622 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39623 sender_domains = gmail.com
39624 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39628 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39629 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39631 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39632 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39633 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39634 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39637 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39638 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39639 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39640 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39643 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39644 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39645 for more information of what they mean.
39651 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39652 .cindex SPF verification
39654 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39655 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39656 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39657 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
39659 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39660 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39662 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39663 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39664 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
39665 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
39666 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
39668 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39669 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39670 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39671 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39674 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39675 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
39676 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39677 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39678 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39682 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39685 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39686 domain in the envelope-from address.
39688 .vitem &%softfail%&
39689 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39693 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39696 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39697 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39698 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39700 .vitem &%permerror%&
39701 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39702 You may deny messages when this occurs.
39704 .vitem &%temperror%&
39705 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39706 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39709 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39710 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39711 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39712 short-circuit fashion.
39717 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39718 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39719 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39720 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39721 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39722 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39723 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39724 ip=$sender_host_address
39727 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39730 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
39732 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39733 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39734 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39735 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39736 it for logging purposes.
39738 .vitem &$spf_received$&
39739 .vindex &$spf_received$&
39740 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39741 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39742 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39743 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39745 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39746 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39748 .vitem &$spf_result$&
39749 .vindex &$spf_result$&
39750 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39751 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39754 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39755 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39756 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39757 and required in order to obtain a result.
39759 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39760 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39761 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39762 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39766 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39767 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39768 .cindex SPF "best guess"
39769 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39770 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39771 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39773 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39774 for a description of what it means.
39775 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
39777 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39778 of the spf one. For example:
39781 deny spf_guess = fail
39782 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39785 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39786 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39787 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39790 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39791 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39793 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39794 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39795 &%spf_guess%& option.
39796 For example, the following:
39799 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39802 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39805 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39807 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39808 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39811 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39814 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
39815 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39816 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39822 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39824 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39826 .cindex "proxy support"
39827 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
39829 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39830 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39833 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39834 .cindex proxy inbound
39835 .cindex proxy "server side"
39836 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39837 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39839 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39840 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39841 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39844 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
39845 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
39847 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39848 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39849 to distribute load.
39850 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39851 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39852 There is no logging if a host passes or
39853 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39854 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39856 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39857 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39858 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39859 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39860 automatically determines which version is in use.
39862 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39863 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39864 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39865 Exim and the proxy server.
39867 The following expansion variables are usable
39868 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39871 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39872 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39873 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39874 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39875 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39877 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39878 there was a protocol error.
39880 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39881 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39882 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39883 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39884 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39885 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39886 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39887 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39888 A possible solution is:
39890 # Set max number of connections per host
39892 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39893 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39895 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39896 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39901 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39902 .cindex proxy outbound
39903 .cindex proxy "client side"
39904 .cindex proxy SOCKS
39905 .cindex SOCKS proxy
39906 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39907 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39908 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39911 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39912 on an smtp transport.
39913 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39914 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39915 Each proxy specifier is a list
39916 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
39917 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39919 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39920 The list of options is in the following table:
39922 &'auth '& authentication method
39923 &'name '& authentication username
39924 &'pass '& authentication password
39926 &'tmo '& connection timeout
39928 &'weight '& selection bias
39931 More details on each of these options follows:
39934 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
39935 .cindex proxy authentication
39936 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39937 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39938 for access to the proxy.
39939 Default is &"none"&.
39941 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39944 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39947 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39950 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39953 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39954 higher values being tried first.
39955 The default priority is 1.
39957 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39958 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39959 weighted by this value.
39960 The default value for selection bias is 1.
39963 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39964 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39965 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39967 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
39968 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39969 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39970 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39972 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39973 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39975 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39976 "Internationalisation""
39977 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
39980 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39982 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39983 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39984 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39986 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39987 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39988 requirement, upon libidn2.
39990 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39991 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39992 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39993 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39994 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39995 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39997 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39998 international handling for the message is enabled and
39999 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40001 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40002 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40003 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40004 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40006 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40007 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40008 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40009 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40011 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40012 components expanded to a-label form,
40013 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40016 .cindex log protocol
40017 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40018 .cindex i18n logging
40019 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40020 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40022 The following expansion operators can be used:
40024 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40025 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40026 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40027 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40030 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40031 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40033 may use the following modifier:
40035 control = utf8_downconvert
40036 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40038 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40039 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40040 Message Submission Agent context.
40041 If a value is appended it may be:
40043 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40044 &`0 `& no downconversion
40045 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40048 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40049 is initially set to -1.
40052 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40053 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40054 and it overrides any previously set value.
40058 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40059 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40060 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40062 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40063 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40064 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40066 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40067 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40071 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40072 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40073 the following expansion operator can be used:
40075 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40078 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40079 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40080 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40082 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40083 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40084 (which has to be a single character)
40085 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40086 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40088 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40089 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40091 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40092 by many other IMAP servers.
40096 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40097 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40098 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40101 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40102 must be representable in UTF-16.
40105 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40106 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40108 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40112 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40113 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40114 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40115 processing actions.
40117 Most installations will never need to use Events.
40118 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40119 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40121 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40122 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40123 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40125 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40126 An example might look like:
40127 .cindex logging custom
40129 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40130 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40131 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40132 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40133 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40134 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40135 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40136 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40137 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40141 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40142 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40143 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40145 The current list of events is:
40147 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40148 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
40149 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40150 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40151 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40152 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40153 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40154 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40155 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40156 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40157 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40158 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40160 New event types may be added in future.
40162 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40163 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40164 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40166 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40167 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40168 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40170 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40171 should define the event action.
40173 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40174 with the event type:
40176 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
40177 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40178 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40179 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40180 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40181 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40182 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
40183 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40184 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40187 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40189 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40190 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40191 the course of its processing:
40193 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40196 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40197 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40199 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40200 a useful way of writing to the main log.
40202 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40203 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40204 following will be forced:
40206 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40207 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40208 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
40210 All other message types ignore the result string, and
40211 no other use is made of it.
40213 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40214 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40217 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40218 chain element received on the connection.
40219 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40222 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40223 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40225 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40226 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40227 .cindex "adding drivers"
40228 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
40229 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40230 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40231 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40234 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40235 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40237 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40239 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40241 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40242 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40243 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40245 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40247 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40250 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40251 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40253 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40254 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40255 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40256 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40257 simple form that most lookups have.
40259 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40260 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40261 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40263 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40266 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40267 as for other drivers and lookups.
40270 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40271 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40272 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40273 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40274 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40276 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40277 the interface that is expected.
40282 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40283 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40285 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40286 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40287 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40288 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40290 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40295 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40296 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40300 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40301 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40302 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40305 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40306 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////